Download Samsung HT-XA100 دليل المستخدم

Transcript
‫‪HT-XA100‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100C‬‬
‫ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ‬
‫ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ‬
‫ﺻﻮّﺭ ﺍﻹﻣﻜﺎﻧﻴﺎﺕ‬
‫ﺷﻜﺮﺍ ﻟﻜﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺮﺍء ﻣﻨﺘﺞ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻻﺳﺘﻼﻡ ﺃﻓﻀﻞ ﺍﻟﺨﺪﻣﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺮﺟﺎء ﺗﺴﺠﻴﻞ ﻣﻨﺘﺠﻜﻢ ﻓﻲ‬
‫‪www.samsung.com/global/register‬‬
‫)‪Code No. AH68-02068N(0.0‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:32:59 PM‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd *2-*3‬‬
‫ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻌﺪﺩﺓ ﻭﻣﺆﺍﻟﻒ ‪FM‬‬
‫ﻳﺘﻤﻴﺰ ‪ HT-XA100/XA100C‬ﺑﺎﻟﻘﺪﺭﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻌﺪﺩﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺿﻤﻦ ‪DVD-AUDIO، DVD-VIDEO، CD، MP3-CD، WMA-CD،‬‬
‫‪ ،DivX، CD-R/RW‬ﻭ‪ DVD-R/RW‬ﻣﻊ ﻣﺆﺍﻟﻒ ‪ FM‬ﻓﻲ ﻣﺸﻐّﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﺑﺎﻟﻎ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﻘﻴﺪ‪.‬‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﻣﻤﻴﺰﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐّﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻠﺤﻘﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻮﺍﺑﻊ‬
‫ﺍﻓﺤﺺ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﺤﻘﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻮﺍﺑﻊ ﺍﻟﻤﺰﻭﺩ ﺑﻬﺎ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﻠﻲ‬
‫ﺗﻄﺎﺑﻖ ‪DVD-Audio‬‬
‫ﺟﺮّﺏ ﺃﺩﺍء ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﻮﻋﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻤﺘﺎﺯﺓ ﺍﻟﻔﺎﺋﻘﺔ ﻟﻘﺮﺹ ‪ .DVD-Audio‬ﺑﻔﻀﻞ ‪ 24-bit/192kHz DAC‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻤﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻳﻤﻴﺰ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐّﻞ ﺑﻨﻮﻋﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﻤﺘﺎﺯ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﻄﺎﻕ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﻨﺎﻣﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺿﻮﺡ ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺨﻔﺾ ﻭﺗﻔﺼﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺩﺩﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﺗﻔﻌﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﺩﻋﻢ ‪USB Host‬‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﻟﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻮﺻﻞ ﻭﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻔﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻬﺰﺓ ﺗﺨﺰﻳﻦ ‪ USB‬ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻲ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻣﺸﻐّﻞ ‪ ،MP3‬ﺫﺍﻛﺮﺓ ‪ ،USB Flash‬ﻭﻏﻴﺮﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪USB HOST‬‬
‫ﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ‪.‬‬
‫‪Dolby Pro Logic II‬‬
‫‪ Dolby Pro Logic II‬ﻫﻮ ﺷﻜﻞ ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ﻟﺘﻘﻨﻴﺔ ﺣﻞ ﺷﻔﺮﺍﺕ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻌﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﻘﻨﻮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﺘﺤﺴﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺳﺎﺱ ‪ Dolby Pro Logic‬ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺟﻮﺩﺓ‪.‬‬
‫‪) DTS‬ﺃﻧﻈﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ(‬
‫‪ DTS‬ﻫﻲ ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﺿﻐﻂ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻭﻃﻮﺭﺗﻬﺎ ﻣﺆﺳﺴﺔ ﺃﻧﻈﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ ‪ ..Digital Theater Systems Inc‬ﻭﺗﺨﺮﺝ ﺻﻮﺕ ﻗﻨﺎﺓ ‪ ٥٫١‬ﺑﺎﻟﺘﺮﺩﺩ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻣﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ‪/‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺎﺕ )ﺣﺠﻢ ‪(AAA‬‬
‫ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ‬
‫ﻫﻮﺍﺋﻲ ‪FM‬‬
‫ﮐﺎﺑﻞ ‪) HDMI‬ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭﻱ(‬
‫ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ )ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ(‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‬
‫ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﺒﻘﻰ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ ﻟﻤﺪﺓ ‪ ٣‬ﺩﻗﺎﺋﻖ‪ ،‬ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺭﻣﺰ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻳﺘﻮﻗﻒ ‪ HT-XA100/XA100C‬ﺁﻟﻴﺎ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﺮﻭﺭ ‪ 20‬ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺗﻮﻓﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ‬
‫ﻳﺴﻤﺢ ‪ HT-XA100/XA100C‬ﻟﻚ ﺑﺎﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺻﻮﺭﺗﻚ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﻀﻠﺔ ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ‪ JPEG‬ﻭ‪ DVD‬ﻭﺍﺿﺒﻄﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺭﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻋﺮﺽ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻤﺼﻨﻮﻉ ﻭﻓﻘﺎ ﻟﻄﻠﺐ ﺍﻟﺰﺑﻮﻥ‬
‫‪ HT-XA100/XA100C‬ﺑﻪ ﺷﻤﺎ ﺍﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﻛﻪ ﺗﺼﻮﻳﺮ ﺩﻟﺨﻮﺍﻩ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻲ ﭘﺨﺶ‪ JPEG DVD‬ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﻛﻨﻴﺪ ﻭ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺗﺼﻮﻳﺮ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ‬
‫ﺩﺳﺘﮕﺎﻩ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﻫﻴﺪ‪.‬‬
‫‪HDMI‬‬
‫ﻳﻨﻘﻞ ‪ HDMI‬ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻟـ ‪ DVD‬ﻓﻲ ﻧﻔﺲ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺰﻭﺩ ﺑﺄﻭﺿﺢ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺗﺰﺍﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ‬
‫ﻗﺪ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻣﺘﺄﺧﺮﺓ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺃﺧﺮﺍﺝ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﺫﺍ ﺗﻢ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ‪ .‬ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺣﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻜﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﻟﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻀﺒﻂ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺗﺄﺟﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻟﻠﺘﺰﺍﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ‪. .‬‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ‪n (HDMI-CEC) +Anynet‬‬
‫‪ + Anynet‬ﻫﻲ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺑﻬﺎ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ ﻟﻬﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺑﻊ ﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ ﺑﻮﺍﺳﻄﺔ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ‪) .HDMI‬ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻣﺘﻮﻓﺮﺓ ﻓﻲ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﺪﻋﻢ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪(.+ Anynet‬‬
‫‪٢‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:05 PM‬‬
‫‪٣‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 2-3‬‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻣﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻮﻃﺎﺕ‬
‫ﺗﺤﺬﻳﺮﺍﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻣﺔ‬
‫ﻻ ﺗﻔﺘﺢ ﺍﻟﻐﻄﺎء ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻲ ﻟﺘﺠﻨﺐ ﺧﻄﺮ ﺍﻹﺻﺎﺑﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺼﺪﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻻ ﻳﻮﺟﺪ ﺃﻱ ﺟﺰء ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺗﺼﻠﻴﺤﻪ‪ .‬ﺍﻟﺮﺟﺎء ﺍﺳﺘﺪﻋﺎء ﺍﻟﻔﻨﻲ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺘﺺ ﺑﺎﻟﺨﺪﻣﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﺗﺸﻴﺮ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻌﻼﻣﺔ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ »ﺍﻟﻔﻮﻟﻄﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺨﻄﺮﺓ« ﺩﺍﺧﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﺴﺒﺐ ﺧﻄﺮ ﺍﻹﺻﺎﺑﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺼﺪﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻀﺮﺭ ﺍﻟﺸﺨﺼﻲ‪.‬‬
‫ﺗﺤﺬﻳﺮ‬
‫ﺧﻄﺮ ﺍﻹﺻﺎﺑﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺼﺪﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ‬
‫ﻻ ﺗﻔﺘﺢ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﺰﺭ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻒ ‪١‬‬
‫ﺗﺸﻴﺮ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻌﻼﻣﺔ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺗﻌﻠﻴﻤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻴﺎﻧﺔ ﺍﻟﻬﺎﻣﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺻﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﺰﺭ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻒ ‪١‬‬
‫ﻣﺸﻐّﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻣﺞ ﻳﺪﺧﻞ ﻓﻲ ﺻﻒ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﺰﺭ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻒ ‪.١‬‬
‫ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺃﺩﻭﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﻀﻮﺍﺑﻂ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻤﺎﺕ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﻡ ﺑﺎﻹﺟﺮﺍءﺍﺕ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺤﺎﻻﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻐﻴﺮﻣﺒﻴﻨﺔ ﻫﻨﺎ ﻗﺪ ﻳﺆﺩﻱ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺗﻌﺮﺿﻚ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻹﺷﻌﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﺨﻄﻴﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﺗﻨﺒﻴﻪ ‪ :‬ﺗﺠﻨﺐ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺮﺽ ﻷﺷﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﺰﺭ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﺋﻴﺔ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻟﻔﺘﺢ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻌﺸﻴﻖ‪.‬‬
‫ﺗﺤﺬﻳﺮ ‪ :‬ﻟﺘﺠﻨﺐ ﺧﻄﺮ ﺍﻟﺤﺮﻳﻖ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺼﺪﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻻ ﺗﻌﺮﺽ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﻟﻠﻤﻄﺮ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺮﻃﻮﺑﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ ﻓﻲ ﻣﻨﺰﻟﻚ ﺗﺘﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﻣﻊ ﻣﺎ ﻫﻮ ﻣﺸﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻓﻲ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻬﻮﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﺼﻘﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺟﻮﺩﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ ﻟﻠﺠﻬﺎﺯ‪ .‬ﻗﻢ‬
‫ﺑﺘﺮﻛﻴﺐ ﻣﺸ ّﻐﻠﻚ ﺃﻓﻘﻴﺎ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺎﻋﺪﺓ ﻣﻨﺎﺳﺒﺔ )ﺃﺛﺎﺙ(‪ ،‬ﻣﻊ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻣﺴﺎﻓﺎﺕ ﻛﺎﻓﻴﺔ ﺣﻮﻟﻪ ﺑﻐﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﺘﻬﻮﻳﺔ )‪ ١٠ ~ ٧٫٥‬ﺳﻢ(‪ .‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ ﻓﺘﺤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻬﻮﻳﺔ‬
‫ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﻐﻄﺎﺓ‪ .‬ﻻ ﺗﻀﻊ ﺃﻱ ﺷﻲء ﺃﻭ ﺃﺟﻬﺰﺓ ﺛﻘﻴﻠﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﻄﺢ ﺍﻟﻤﺸ ّﻐﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﻻ ﺗﻀﻊ ﺍﻟﻤﺸ ّﻐﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻀﺨﻤﺎﺕ ﺃﻭ ﻣﻌﺪﺍﺕ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ ﻗﺪ ﺗﺮﺗﻔﻊ ﺩﺭﺟﺔ ﺣﺮﺍﺭﺗﻬﺎ‪ .‬ﻗﺒﻞ‬
‫ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺸ ّﻐﻞ‪ ،‬ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺻﻴﻨﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻣﺞ ﻓﺎﺭﻏﺔ‪ .‬ﺗﻢ ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﺸ ّﻐﻞ ﻟﻠﻌﻤﻞ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﻤﺮﺍﺭ‪ .‬ﺗﺤﻮﻳﻞ ﻣﺸ ّﻐﻞ ‪ DVD‬ﺍﻟﻰ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﻻ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ‬
‫ﺍﻧﻔﺼﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﻋﻨﻪ‪ .‬ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺸ ّﻐﻞ ﺑﺎﻟﻜﺎﻣﻞ ﻋﻦ ﻣﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭﻱ‪ ،‬ﻳﺠﺐ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﻢ ﻓﺼﻞ ﻗﺎﺑﺲ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﺧﺎﺻﺔ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻋﺪﻡ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺸ ّﻐﻞ ﻟﻤﺪﺓ ﻃﻮﻳﻠﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﺗﻨﺒﻴﻪ ‪ :‬ﻟﻤﻨﻊ ﺍﻟﺼﺪﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺸﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﻳﻀﺔ ﻟﻠﻘﺎﺑﺲ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺜﻘﺐ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﻳﺾ ﺇﺩﺧﺎﻻ ﺗﺎﻣﺎ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﺠﺐ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻣﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻨﺎﻭﺏ ﺑﺸﻜﻞ‬
‫• ﻟﻔﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﺳﺤﺐ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻲ ﻟﻜﻲ ﻳﻜﻦ ﻗﺎﺑﺲ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﻟﻠﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﺗﻨﺒﻴﻪ‬
‫• ﻻ ﺗﻌﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﻄﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﺷﺎﺵ ﻭﻻ ﺗﻀﻊ ﺃﺷﻴﺎء ﻣﻤﺘﻠﺌﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺴﻮﺍﺋﻞ‪ ،‬ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﺰﻫﺮﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻗﺎﺑﺲ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭﻳﺔ ﻛﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻔﺼﻞ ﻭﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﻟﻠﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻓﻲ ﺃﻱ ﻭﻗﺖ‪.‬‬
‫‪[jI≠ W¥œuFº∞« WO°dF∞« ‹UßUOI∞« WLE‬‬
‫]‪Ò M±‬‬
‫≥‪WO°dF∞« ‹UßUOI∞« WLEÒM± ‚bÒB¢ jK≠ 127 f°UÆ vK´ Êu°e∞« qB∫¥ Ê√ sJLL∞« s± .tOK´ W¥œuFº∞« WO°dF∞« ‹UßUOI∞« WLEÒM± ‚bÒB¢ jK≠ 220 f°UÆ l± VßUM± “UNπ∞« «c‬‬
‫ﻻ ﺗﻌﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﻷﺷﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺍﻟﻤﺒﺎﺷﺮﺓ ﺃﻭ ﻣﺼﺎﺩﺭ ﺣﺮﺍﺭﺓ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ‪.‬‬
‫ﻳﺴﺒﺐ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺘﺴﺨﻴﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﺍﺋﺪ ﻭﺳﻮء ﺃﺩﺍء ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﻋﻮﺍﺻﻒ ﺭﻋﺪﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﻓﺼﻞ ﻗﺎﺑﺲ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﻋﻦ ﻣﺨﺮﺝ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭﻱ‪ .‬ﺯﻳﺎﺩﺓ ﻣﻌﺪﻝ ﺍﻟﻔﻮﻟﻄﻴﺔ ﺑﺴﺒﺐ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻕ ﻗﺪ ﻳﻀﺮ ﺑﺎﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ‪.‬‬
‫«∞‪.U≤Uπ± wK∫L∞« d§U∑∞« s± tOK´ W¥œuFº‬‬
‫ﺗﺤﺘﻮﻱ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻌﻤﻠﺔ ﻓﻲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎﺩﺓ ﻛﻴﻤﻴﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﻣﺆﺫﻳﺔ ﻟﻠﺒﻴﺌﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻻ ﺗﺮﻣﻲ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺎﺕ ﻓﻲ ﺳﻠﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺎﻣﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪٤‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:06 PM‬‬
‫ﺍﺣﻔﻆ ﺍﻟﻤﺸ ّﻐﻞ ﺑﻌﻴﺪﺍ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﻃﻮﺑﺔ )ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﺰﻫﺮﻳﺔ(‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺴﺨﻴﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﺍﺋﺪ )ﻣﺜﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺼﻄﻠﻰ( ﺃﻭ ﻣﻌﺪﺍﺕ ﺗﺴﺒﺐ ﺍﻟﺤﻘﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻐﻨﻄﻴﺴﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻲ )ﻣﺜﻞ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‪ (...‬ﺍﻓﺼﻞ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭﻱ‬
‫ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻤﺸ ّﻐﻞ ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺳﻮء ﺍﻷﺩﺍء‪ .‬ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺨﺼﺺ ﻻﻏﺮﺍﺽ‬
‫ﺗﺠﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﺑﻞ ﻻﻏﺮﺍﺽ ﻣﻨﺰﻟﻴﺔ ﻓﻘﻂ‪ .‬ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ ﻻﻏﺮﺍﺽ ﺷﺨﺼﻴﺔ ﻓﻘﻂ‪.‬‬
‫ﻳﺤﺪﺙ ﺗﻜﺜﻒ ﺍﻟﻤﺎء ﺍﺫﺍ ﺗﻢ ﺗﺨﺰﻳﻦ ﻣﺸ ّﻐﻠﻚ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻣﺞ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺠﻮ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺭﺩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻋﻨﺪ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺸ ّﻐﻞ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺸﺘﺎء‪ ،‬ﺍﻧﺘﻈﺮ ﺣﻮﺍﻟﻲ ﺳﺎﻋﺘﻴﻦ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎ ﺣﺘﻰ ﻳﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺩﺭﺟﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺤﺮﺍﺭﺓ ﻟﻠﻐﺮﻓﺔ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ‪.‬‬
‫‪٥‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 4-5‬‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺤﺘﻮﻳﺎﺕ‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ‬
‫ﻣﻤﻴﺰﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐّﻞ‬
‫‪٢‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻠﻘﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻮﺍﺑﻊ‬
‫ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻣﺔ‬
‫‪٤‬‬
‫‪٥‬‬
‫ﺗﺤﺬﻳﺮﺍﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻣﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻮﻃﺎﺕ‬
‫‪٨‬‬
‫‪٩‬‬
‫‪٩‬‬
‫‪٩‬‬
‫‪١٠‬‬
‫ﻗﺒﻞ ﻗﺮﺍءﺓ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ‬
‫ﺍﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺑﻠﺔ ﻟﻼﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎﻝ‬
‫ﻻ ﺗﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﺃﻧﻮﺍﻉ ﺍﻻﻗﺮﺍﺹ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻟﻴﺔ‬
‫ﺣﻤﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺦ‬
‫ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﻭﺍﻟﺨﻮﺍﺹ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻒ‬
‫‪١١‬‬
‫‪١٢‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻴﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ‬
‫ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‬
‫‪١٣‬‬
‫‪١٤‬‬
‫ﻭﺻﻒ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‬
‫‪١٧‬‬
‫‪١٩‬‬
‫‪٢١‬‬
‫‪٢٣‬‬
‫‪٢٤‬‬
‫‪٢٦‬‬
‫ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻣﻀﺨﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ‬
‫ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ‪ Video Out‬ﺍﻟﻰ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻧﻚ‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪HDMI‬‬
‫ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻤﻜﻮﻧﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻴﺔ‬
‫ﺗﺼﻮﻳﻞ ﻫﻮﺍﺋﻲ ‪FM‬‬
‫‪٢‬‬
‫‪٤‬‬
‫ﺑﺪء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫‪٨‬‬
‫‪١١‬‬
‫‪١٣‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻼﺕ‬
‫‪١٧‬‬
‫ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ‬
‫‪٢٧‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫‪٢٨‬‬
‫‪٦‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:06 PM‬‬
‫‪٤٣‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺩﻳﻮ‬
‫‪٥٤‬‬
‫‪٥٥‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻮﻇﺎﺋﻒ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻳﺤﺔ‬
‫‪٥٥‬‬
‫‪٥٥‬‬
‫‪٥٥‬‬
‫‪٥٥‬‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻣﺆﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻡ‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﺳﻄﻮﻉ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻛﺘﻢ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺠﻬﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻱ‬
‫‪٥٦‬‬
‫‪٥٨‬‬
‫‪٢٨‬‬
‫‪٢٩‬‬
‫‪٣٠‬‬
‫‪٣١‬‬
‫‪٣٣‬‬
‫‪٤١‬‬
‫‪٥٤‬‬
‫‪٥٤‬‬
‫ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻤﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺩﻳﻮ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻄﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺒﻘﺔ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ‬
‫ﺗﺤﺮﻱ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻞ ﻭﺇﺻﻼﺣﻪ‬
‫ﻣﻨﺘﻮﺟﺎﺕ ﺗﺪﻋﻢ ﻣﻤﻴﺰﺓ ‪USB HOST‬‬
‫ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‬
‫ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪MP3/WMA-CD‬‬
‫ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻣﻠﻒ ‪JPEG‬‬
‫ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ‪DivX‬‬
‫ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻣﻠﻔﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻮﺳﻂ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻣﻤﻴﺰﺓ ‪USB Host‬‬
‫‪٤٣‬‬
‫‪٤٤‬‬
‫‪٤٥‬‬
‫‪٤٥‬‬
‫‪٤٦‬‬
‫‪٤٦‬‬
‫‪٤٧‬‬
‫‪٤٧‬‬
‫‪٤٨‬‬
‫‪٤٩‬‬
‫‪٤٩‬‬
‫‪٥٠‬‬
‫‪٥١‬‬
‫‪٥١‬‬
‫‪٥٢‬‬
‫‪٥٣‬‬
‫‪٥٣‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺔ‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﺍﻷﺑﻮﻱ )ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺘﻘﺪﻳﺮ(‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻭﺭ‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﻭﺭﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭ‬
‫ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ‪ ٣‬ﺿﻮﺍﺑﻂ ﻟﻮﺭﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭ‬
‫ﻭﺿﻊ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ‪DVD‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﻭﺿﻊ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺟﻴﻞ‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﻧﺒﺮﺓ ﺍﻻﺧﺘﺒﺎﺭ‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ‪) DRC‬ﺿﻐﻂ ﺍﻟﻨﻄﺎﻕ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﻨﺎﻣﻲ(‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﺗﺰﺍﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺩﻳﻮ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﺃﻭﺩﻳﻮ ‪HDMI‬‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻧﻄﺎﻕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ )‪ / (DSP‬ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺍﺯﻥ‬
‫ﻭﺿﻊ ‪Dolby Pro Logic II‬‬
‫ﺗﺄﺛﻴﺮ ‪Dolby Pro Logic II‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻠﺤﻘﺎﺕ‬
‫‪٥٩‬‬
‫‪٥٨‬‬
‫‪٥٨‬‬
‫‪٥٨‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻣﻴﺮﺍ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ‬
‫ﻗﺮﺹ ‪USB Flash‬‬
‫ﻣﺸﻐّﻞ ‪MP3‬‬
‫‪٥٩‬‬
‫‪٦٠‬‬
‫‪٦١‬‬
‫ﺟﺪﻭﻝ ﺭﻣﺰ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺔ‬
‫ﺗﺤﻮﻃﺎﺕ ﺣﻮﻝ ﻣﻌﺎﻟﺠﺔ ﺍﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ ﻭﺗﺨﺰﻧﻴﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺍﺻﻔﺎﺕ‬
‫‪٧‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 6-7‬‬
‫ﻗﺒﻞ ﻗﺮﺍءﺓ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ‬
‫‪~ 6‬‬
‫‪1‬‬
‫ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻓﺤﺺ ﺍﻟﻤﺼﻄﻠﺤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻟﻴﺔ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻗﺮﺍءﺓ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻻﻳﻘﻮﻧﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻓﻲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺪﻟﻴﻞ‬
‫ﻣﺼﻄﻠﺢ‬
‫‪DVD‬‬
‫‪DVD‬‬
‫‪B‬‬
‫‪A‬‬
‫‪G‬‬
‫‪CD‬‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﻳﺸﻤﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻣﺘﻮﻓﺮﺓ ﻓﻲ ﻗﺮﺹ ﻣﺪﻣﺞ ﻟﻠﺒﻴﺎﻧﺎﺕ )‪ CD-R‬ﺃﻭ ‪.(CD-RW‬‬
‫‪MP٣‬‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﻳﺸﻤﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻣﺘﻮﻓﺮﺓ ﻓﻲ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪.CD-R/CD-RW‬‬
‫‪JPEG‬‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﻳﺸﻤﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻣﺘﻮﻓﺮﺓ ﻓﻲ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪.CD-R/CD-RW‬‬
‫‪DivX‬‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﻳﺸﻤﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻣﺘﻮﻓﺮﺓ ﻓﻲ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ‪ DVD-R/RW، CD-R) MPEG٤‬ﺃﻭ ‪.(CD-RW‬‬
‫ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ﻗﺎﺑﻠﺔ ﻟﻼﺗﺴﻌﻤﺎﻝ‬
‫ﺃﻧﻮﺍﻉ ﺍﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺮﻣﻮﺯ‬
‫ﺃﻧﻮﺍﻉ ﺍﻟﺘﺴﺠﻴﻞ‬
‫ﺣﺠﻢ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‬
‫‪ 12‬ﺳﻢ‬
‫‪D‬‬
‫‪Caution‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﻳﺸﻤﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻣﺘﻮﻓﺮﺓ ﻓﻲ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ DVD‬ﺃﻭ ‪ DVD-R/DVD-RW‬ﺗﻢ ﺗﺴﺠﻴﻠﻬﺎ ﻭﺗﺼﻮﻳﻐﻬﺎ ﻓﻲ‬
‫ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ‪.‬‬
‫ّ‬
‫ﺗﺸﻔﺮ ﺃﺟﻬﺰﺓ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ‪ DVD‬ﻭﺍﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ ﺣﺴﺐ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺎﻃﻖ‪ .‬ﻳﺠﺐ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻼﺋﻢ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﻮﺯ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﻄﻘﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪ .‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻟﻢ ﺗﻼﺋﻢ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﻮﺯ‪ ،‬ﻟﻦ ﻳﺘﻢ‬
‫ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪.‬‬
‫ﻳﻌﺮﺽ ﺭﻗﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﻘﻄﺔ ﻟﻬﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﺸ ّﻐﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ ﻟﻠﻤﺸ ّﻐﻞ‪.‬‬
‫)ﻣﺸ ّﻐﻞ ‪ DVD‬ﻣﻊ ﻧﻔﺲ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﺰ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﻄﻘﻲ ﺳﻴﺸ ّﻐﻞ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ DVD‬ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﻠﺼﻖ ﺭﻗﻌﺘﻬﺎ ﻣﻊ ﺭﻣﻮﺯ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﺔ ﺍﻟﻬﻮﻳﺔ‪(.‬‬
‫‪Note‬‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﻳﺸﻤﻞ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﻻ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺃﻭ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺇﻟﻐﺎء ﺍﻟﻀﻮﺍﺑﻂ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫‪DVD-AUDIO‬‬
‫ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ‪+‬ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ‬
‫‪DVD-VIDEO‬‬
‫‪ 8‬ﺳﻢ‬
‫‪AUDIO-CD‬‬
‫‪COMPACT‬‬
‫ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ‬
‫‪DIGITAL AUDIO‬‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﻳﺸﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﻠﻴﻤﺎﺕ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺤﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﺴﺎﻋﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻛﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪DivX‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻓﻲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺪﻟﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﺘﻌﻠﻴﻤﺎﺕ ﺫﺍﺕ »‪) DVD‬‬
‫‪DVD‬‬
‫ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ‪+‬ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ‬
‫● ﺑﺪء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻳﻘﻮﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺑﺪء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫ﻳﻌﻄﻰ ‪) DVD‬ﻗﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ(‬
‫ﺻﻮﺗﺎ ﻭﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻣﻤﺘﺎﺯﺓ ﺑﻔﻀﻞ ﺻﻮﺕ ﺩﻭﻟﺒﻲ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻴﻂ ﻭﺗﻘﻨﻴﺔ ﺿﻐﻂ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ ‪ .MPEG-2‬ﺍﻵﻥ ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻤﺘﺎﻉ ﺑﻬﺬﻩ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺛﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺤﻘﻴﻘﻴﺔ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻝ‪ ،‬ﻣﺜﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﻧﻚ ﻓﻲ ﻣﺴﺮﺡ ﺳﻴﻨﻤﺎﺋﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺻﺎﻟﺔ ﺣﻔﻠﺔ ﻣﻮﺳﻴﻘﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺤﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ‬
‫ﺣﻮﺍﻟﻲ ‪ 240‬ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ )ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻪ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺪ(‬
‫ﺣﻮﺍﻟﻲ ‪ 480‬ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ )ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻬﺎﻥ(‬
‫ﺣﻮﺍﻟﻲ ‪ 80‬ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ )ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻪ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺪ(‬
‫ﺣﻮﺍﻟﻲ ‪ 160‬ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ )ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻬﺎﻥ(‬
‫‪ 12‬ﺳﻢ‬
‫‪ 74‬ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ‬
‫‪ 8‬ﺳﻢ‬
‫‪ 20‬ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ‬
‫‪ 12‬ﺳﻢ‬
‫‪ 74‬ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ‬
‫‪ 8‬ﺳﻢ‬
‫‪ 20‬ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ‬
‫(« ﻗﺎﺑﻠﺔ ﻟﻼﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎﻝ ﻓﻲ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ DVD-VIDEO، DVD-AUDIO‬ﻭ‬
‫‪ DVD-R/-RW‬ﺗﻢ ﺗﺴﺠﻴﻠﻬﺎ ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻭﺗﺼﻮﻳﻐﻬﺎ‪ .‬ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻳﺬﻛﺮ ﻧﻮﻉ ‪ DVD‬ﺧﺎﺹ‪ ،‬ﻳﺸﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻨﻔﺼﻼ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻟﻢ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺴﺠﻴﻞ ﻗﺮﺹ ‪ DVD-R/-RW‬ﺑﺸﻜﻞ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ ﺑﺘﺼﻤﻴﻢ ‪ ،DVD Video‬ﻓﻠﻦ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪.‬‬
‫ﺣﻮﻝ ﻛﻴﻔﻴﺔ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎﻝ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ‬
‫‪ (1‬ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻻﻃﻼﻉ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﻌﻠﻴﻤﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻣﺔ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ‪) .‬ﺍﻧﻈﺮ ﺻﻔﺤﺔ ‪(٤ ~ ٣‬‬
‫ﻻ ﺗﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﺃﻧﻮﺍﻉ ﺍﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻟﻴﺔ !‬
‫• ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ CD-G، CD-I، CD-ROM، DVD-ROM‬ﻭ‪ DVD-RAM‬ﻓﻲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐﻞ‪ .‬ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﺸﻐﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ‪ ،‬ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺭﺳﺎﻟﺔ‬
‫>‪ <WRONG DISC FORMAT‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﺗﺸﻐﻞ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ DVD‬ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﺸﺘﺮﻳﻬﺎ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺝ ﻓﻲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﺸﻐﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ‪ ،‬ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺭﺳﺎﻟﺔ >‪<CAN’T PLAY THIS DISC PELASE, CHECK REGION CODE‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫‪ (2‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﺣﺪﺛﺖ ﻣﺸﻜﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﻓﺤﺺ ﺗﺤﺮﻱ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻞ ﻭﺇﺻﻼﺣﻪ‪) .‬ﺍﻧﻈﺮ ﺻﻔﺤﺘﻴﻦ ‪(٥٧ ~ ٥٦‬‬
‫ﺣﻘﻮﻕ ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻊ‬
‫‪©Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd 2008‬‬
‫ﻛﻞ ﺍﻟﺤﻘﻮﻕ ﻣﺤﻔﻮﻇﺔ ‪ :‬ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺘﻢ ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺇﻧﺘﺎﺝ ﺃﻭ ﻧﺴﺦ ﺃﻱ ﺟﺰء ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻜﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺩﻭﻥ ﺇﺫﻥ ﻣﻜﺘﻮﺏ ﻣﺴﺒﻖ ﻟﺸﺮﻛﺔ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ‬
‫ﻟﻼﻟﻜﺘﺮﻭﻧﻴﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﺪﻭﺩﺓ‪.‬‬
‫‪٨‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:07 PM‬‬
‫ﺣﻤﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺦ‬
‫ﺗﻮﺻﻞ ﻣﺸﻐّﻞ ‪ DVD‬ﺍﻟﻰ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻧﻚ ﺑﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻣﺒﺎﺷﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻟﻴﺲ ﻣﻊ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ‪ .‬ﻋﻨﺪ‬
‫• ﺗﺸﻔّﺮ ﻛﺜﻴﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ DVD‬ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﻣﻨﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺦ‪ .‬ﺑﺴﺒﺐ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻳﺠﺐ ﺃﻥ ّ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻣﻊ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ‪ ،‬ﺗﻮﺟﺪ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻣﺸﻮﻫﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ DVD‬ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﻳﻤﻨﻊ ﻧﺴﺨﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﺘﻜﺎﻣﻞ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ ﺗﻘﻨﻴﺔ ﻣﻨﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺦ ﻋﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﻃﻠﺐ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﺍءﺍﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﺮﻳﻜﻴﺔ ﻭﺣﻘﻮﻕ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻜﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻔﻜﺮﻳﺔ ﺍﻷﺧﺮﻯ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﻤﻠﻚ ‪ Macrovision Corporation‬ﻭﻣﺎﻟﻚ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺤﻘﻮﻕ ﺍﻷﺧﺮﻯ‪ .‬ﻳﺠﺐ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﻔﻮﻳﺾ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺗﻘﻨﻴﺔ ﻣﻨﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺦ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻞ ‪ ،Macrovision Corporation‬ﻭﻳﺴﺘﻌﻤﻞ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻝ ﻭﻟﻐﺮﺽ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ‬
‫ﻣﺤﺪﺩﺓ ﻓﻘﻂ‪ ،‬ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻟﻐﺮﺽ ﺁﺧﺮ‪ ،‬ﻳﺠﺐ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻮﺍﻓﻖ ‪ Macrovision Corporation‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ .‬ﻳﻤﻨﻊ ﺗﻔﻜﻴﻚ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﻭﺍﻟﻬﻨﺪﺳﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻜﺴﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪٩‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 8-9‬‬
‫ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﻭﺍﻟﺨﻮﺍﺹ‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺑﺪء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻒ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻴﺔ‬
‫ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ ﻻ ﻳﺪﻋﻢ ﻣﻠﻔﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻮﺳﻂ ﺍﻵﻣﻨﺔ )‪.(DRM‬‬
‫‪٩‬‬
‫‪٨‬‬
‫‪٧‬‬
‫‪٥‬‬
‫‪٦‬‬
‫‪٣‬‬
‫‪٤‬‬
‫‪٢‬‬
‫‪١‬‬
‫❖ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪CD-R‬‬
‫● ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻒ‬
‫• ﺍﻋﺘﻤﺎﺩﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺗﺴﺠﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ )ﻣﺴﺠﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻣﺞ ﺃﻭ ﻛﻮﻣﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ( ﻭﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪.CD-R‬‬
‫• ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻗﺮﺹ ‪ CD-R‬ﺑﺤﺠﻢ ‪ 650‬ﻣﻴﻐﺎﺑﻴﺖ‪ 74/‬ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ‪ .‬ﻻ ﺗﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ‪) CD-R media‬ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﻹﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺑﺔ( ﻷﻧﻪ ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻠﻪ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻤﻜﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻻ ﺗﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ‪) CD-RW media‬ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﻹﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺑﺔ( ﺣﻴﺚ ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻠﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ CD-R‬ﻓﻘﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﻳﺘﻢ »ﺇﻏﻼﻗﻬﺎ« ﺑﺎﻟﻜﺎﻣﻞ‪ .‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺠﺰء ﻣﻐﻠﻘﺎ ﺇﻻ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﻇﻞ ﻣﻔﺘﻮﺣﺎ‪ ،‬ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﺑﺎﻟﻜﺎﻣﻞ‪.‬‬
‫❖ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪CD-R MP3‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﻓﻘﻂ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ CD-R‬ﺫﺍﺕ ﻣﻠﻔﺎﺕ ‪ MP3‬ﺫﺍﺕ ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ‪ ISO 9660‬ﺃﻭ ‪.Joliet‬‬
‫• ﻳﺠﺐ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﺣﺮﻭﻑ ﺍﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻒ ﻟﻘﺮﺹ ‪ MP3 8‬ﺣﺮﻭﻑ ﺃﻭ ﺃﻗﻞ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻝ ﻭ ﺃﻥ ﻻ ﺗﺤﻮﻱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻱ ﻓﺮﺍﻍ ﺃﻭ ﺃﺷﻜﺎﻝ ﺧﺎﺻﺔ )‪.(+ = / .‬‬
‫• ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ﺗﻢ ﺗﺴﺠﻴﻠﻬﺎ ﺑﻨﺴﺒﺔ ﺑﻴﺎﻧﺎﺕ ﻣﻀﻐﻮﻃﺔ‪/‬ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﻀﻐﻮﻃﺔ ﺃﻛﺒﺮ ﻣﻦ ‪.Kbps 128‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﻓﻘﻂ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻔﺎﺕ ﺫﺍﺕ ﺍﻷﺑﻌﺎﺩ »‪ «.mp3‬ﻭ »‪.«.MP3‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻌﺪﺩ ﺍﻷﺟﺰﺍء ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺠﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺎﻗﺐ‪ .‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺟﺰء ﻓﺮﺍﻍ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻌﺪﺩ ﺍﻷﺟﺰﺍء‪ ،‬ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﻟﻠﻘﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺣﺘﻰ ﺟﺰء‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺍﻍ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﺫﺍ ﻟﻢ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺇﻏﻼﻕ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺴﺘﻐﺮﻕ ﻃﻮﻳﻼ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺑﺪء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻭﻟﻦ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻔﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺠﻠﺔ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻟﻠﻤﻠﻔﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻔﺮﺓ ﺑﺘﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﻧﺴﺒﺔ ﺑﻴﺖ ﻣﺘﻨﻮﻋﺔ )‪ ،(VBR : Variable Bit Rate‬ﻣﺜﻼ ﻣﻠﻔﺎﺕ ﻣﺸﻔﺮﺓ ﺑﻨﺴﺒﺔ ﺑﻴﺖ ﻣﻨﺨﻔﺾ ﻭﻧﺴﺒﺔ ﺑﻴﺖ ﻣﺮﺗﻔﻊ‬
‫)ﻣﺜﻼ‪ ،(Kbps 32 ~ 320 Kbps ،‬ﻗﺪ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺣﺬﻑ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﺫﺍ ﺗﻢ ﺗﺴﺠﻴﻞ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ‪ 500‬ﻣﺴﺎﺭﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺮﺹ ﻣﺪﻣﺞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ‪ 500‬ﻣﺴﺎﺭﺍ ﻛﺤﺪ ﺃﻗﺼﻰ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﺫﺍ ﺗﻢ ﺗﺴﺠﻴﻞ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ‪ 300‬ﻣﻨﺤﻨﻴﺎﺕ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺮﺹ ﻣﺪﻣﺞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ‪ 300‬ﻣﻨﺤﻨﻰ ﻛﺤﺪ ﺃﻗﺼﻰ‪.‬‬
‫‪١٠‬‬
‫‪١١‬‬
‫‪١٢‬‬
‫❖ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪CD-R JPEG‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﻓﻘﻂ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻣﻠﻔﺎﺕ ﺫﺍﺕ ﺗﻤﺪﻳﺪ »‪.«jpeg.‬‬
‫• ﺍﺫﺍ ﻟﻢ ﻳﻜﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﻣﻐﻠﻘﺎ‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺴﺘﻐﺮﻕ ﻭﻗﺘﺎ ﺃﻃﻮﻝ ﻟﺒﺪء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻭﻗﺪ ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻔﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﻢ ﺗﺴﺠﻴﻠﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﻓﻘﻂ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ CD-R‬ﺫﺍﺕ ﻣﻠﻔﺎﺕ ‪ JPEG‬ﺑﺘﺼﻤﻴﻢ ‪ ISO 9660‬ﺃﻭ ‪.Joliet‬‬
‫• ﻳﺠﺐ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﺣﺮﻭﻑ ﺍﺳﻢ ﻣﻠﻒ ﻗﺮﺹ ‪ JPEG 8‬ﺣﺮﻭﻑ ﺃﻭ ﺃﻗﻞ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻝ ﻭ ﺃﻥ ﻻ ﺗﺤﺘﻮﻱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻱ ﻓﺮﺍﻍ ﺃﻭ ﻋﻼﻣﺎﺕ ﺧﺎﺻﺔ )‪.(+ = / .‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﻓﻘﻂ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻗﺮﺹ ﻣﺘﻌﺪﺩ ﺍﻷﺟﺰﺍء ﻣﺴﺠﻞ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﻌﺎﻗﺐ‪ .‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺟﺰء ﻓﺮﺍﻍ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻌﺪﺩ ﺍﻷﺟﺰﺍء‪ ،‬ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﻟﻠﻘﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺣﺘﻰ ﺟﺰء ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺍﻍ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﺨﺰﻳﻦ ‪9.999‬ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻛﺄﻗﺼﻰ ﺣﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺮﺹ ﻣﺪﻣﺞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻗﺮﺹ ﻣﺪﻣﺞ ﻟـ ‪ ،Kodak/Fuji Picture‬ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻣﻠﻔﺎﺕ ‪ JPEG‬ﻓﻲ ﻣﻨﺤﻨﻰ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻓﻘﻂ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﺴﺘﻐﺮﻕ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻻﻗﺮﺍﺹ ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻣﺠﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﺋﻴﺔ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺜﻨﺎء ‪ Kodak/Fuji Picture‬ﻭﻗﺘﺎ ﺃﻃﻮﻝ ﺃﻭ ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻠﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺒﺘﺔ‪.‬‬
‫❖ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ DVD-R/RW، CD-R/RW‬ﻭ‪DivX‬‬
‫• ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻣﻠﻒ ‪ DivX‬ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺻﻨﻌﻪ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻣﺒﺎﺷﺮﺓ ﻷﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﻳﺰﻭﺩ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻔﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﺘﻤﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻞ ‪ .DivX Networks, Inc‬ﻓﻘﻂ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻻ ﻳﺪﻋﻢ ﺗﺤﺪﻳﺚ ﺍﻟﺪﺭﺟﺔ ﻟﻠﺒﺮﻧﺎﻣﺞ ﻟﻠﺘﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﺴﺎﻭﻕ‪) .‬ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ‪ ،QPEL، GMC :‬ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻮﺡ ﺃﻛﺒﺮ ﻣﻦ ‪ 600 × 800‬ﻓﻴﻜﺴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﻴﺮﻫﺎ(‬
‫• ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻷﺟﺰﺍء ﺫﺍﺕ ﻧﺴﺒﺔ ﺍﻹﻃﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﺗﻔﻌﺔ ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻣﻠﻒ ‪.DivX‬‬
‫• ﻟﻠﺤﺼﻮﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺘﺼﺎﻣﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﺘﻤﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻞ ‪ ،.DivX Networks, Inc‬ﻳﺮﺟﻰ ﺯﻳﺎﺭﺓ »‪.«www.divxnetworks.net‬‬
‫‪١٠‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:07 PM‬‬
‫‪٥‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺍﻟﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺃﺳﻔﻞ ﻭ ﺍﻟﺘﺨﻄﻲ ) (‬
‫‪٩‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ )¦(‬
‫‪١٠‬‬
‫ﻣﻘﺒﺲ ‪AUX IN 1‬‬
‫‪١١‬‬
‫ﻣﻘﺒﺲ ﺳﻤﺎﻋﺔ ﺍﻟﺮﺃﺱ‬
‫‪١٢‬‬
‫ﻓﺘﺤﺔ ‪USB‬‬
‫‪١‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ )‬
‫‪٢‬‬
‫ﺻﻴﻨﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‬
‫‪٦‬‬
‫‪٣‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻹﺧﺮﺍﺝ‬
‫‪٧‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪/‬ﺍﻟﺘﻮﻗﻒ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﻗﺖ ) (‬
‫‪٤‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ‬
‫‪٨‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺍﻟﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺃﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺨﻄﻲ ) (‬
‫(‬
‫‪١١‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 10-11‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‬
‫‪٦‬‬
‫‪٥‬‬
‫‪٤‬‬
‫‪٣‬‬
‫‪٢‬‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻒ‬
‫ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﺎﺋﻒ ﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻧﻚ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‪.‬‬
‫‪١‬‬
‫ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‬
‫● ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‬
‫‪ ١‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) TV‬ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ( ﻟﻜﻲ ﻳﻀﺒﻂ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺿﻊ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) POWER‬ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ( ﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ٣‬ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﻣﺴﻚ ﺯﺭ ‪) POWER‬ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ(‪ ،‬ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﻔﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺎﺳﺒﺔ ﻟﻤﺎﺭﻛﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺹ ﺑﻚ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺷﻔﺮﺓ ﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻧﻚ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﺷﻔﺮﺓ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﻔﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺎﺳﺒﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻣﺜﻼ ‪ :‬ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ‬
‫ﻋﻨﺪ ﻣﺴﻚ ﺯﺭ ‪) POWER‬ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ( ﺍﻷﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳﺔ ﻹﺩﺧﺎﻝ ‪،00‬‬
‫‪ 17 ،16 ،15‬ﺃﻭ ‪.40‬‬
‫‪٧‬‬
‫‪٨‬‬
‫‪٩‬‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﺗﻢ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﺬﺍ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺇﻛﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﻋﻤﻠﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺃﺯﺭﺍﺭ ‪) TV POWER‬ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﻟﻠﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ(‪) VOLUME ،‬ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ(‪) CHANNEL ،‬ﺍﻟﻘﻨﺎﺓ(‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻷﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳﺔ )‪.(9 ~ 0‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪١‬‬
‫ﻭﺻﻼﺕ ﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺑﻘﻨﺎﺓ ‪5.1‬‬
‫ﺻﻞ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪٢‬‬
‫ﻣﻘﺒﺲ ﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ‬
‫ﺻﻞ ﻣﻘﺒﺲ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻧﻚ )‪ (VIDEO IN‬ﺍﻟﻰ ﻣﻘﺒﺲ ‪VIDEO OUT‬‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ‪.‬‬
‫‪٣‬‬
‫ﻣﻘﺎﺑﺲ ﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﻤﻜﻮﻥ‬
‫ﺻﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻣﻊ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﻤﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻤﻘﺎﺑﺲ‬
‫‪٤‬‬
‫ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ‪TX‬‬
‫ﺗﺴﻤﺢ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ‪ TX‬ﺍﻻﺗﺼﺎﻻﺕ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ ﻭﻣﻀﺨﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ‬
‫ﺍﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭﻱ‪.‬‬
‫‪٥‬‬
‫ﻣﻘﺒﺲ ﺧﺮﺝ ‪) HDMI‬ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭﻱ(‬
‫ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ‪ HDMI‬ﻭﺻﻞ ﻃﺮﻑ ﺧﺮﺝ ‪ HDMI‬ﺍﻟﻰ ﻃﺮﻑ ﺩﺧﻞ ‪ HDMI‬ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻧﻚ ﻷﻓﻀﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻋﻴﺔ ﻟﻠﺼﻮﺭﺓ‪.‬‬
‫‪٦‬‬
‫ﻣﻘﺒﺲ ﻣﺘﺤﺪ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻮﺭ ‪Ω FM 75‬‬
‫ﺻﻞ ﻫﻮﺍﺋﻲ ‪.FM‬‬
‫‪٧‬‬
‫ﻣﻘﺒﺲ ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﺼﺮﻱ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻲ‬
‫ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﺪﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺑﻠﺔ ﻟﻠﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ‪.‬‬
‫‪٨‬‬
‫ﻣﻘﺒﺲ ‪AUX IN 2‬‬
‫ﺻﻞ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻷﻧﺎﻟﻮﺟﻲ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﻨﺎﺗﻴﻦ ﻟﻠﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻲ )ﻣﺜﻞ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ(‬
‫‪٩‬‬
‫ﻣﺮﻭﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺒﺮﻳﺪ‬
‫ﺗﺪﻭﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻭﺣﺔ ﺩﺍﺋﻤﺎ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ‪ .‬ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﻓﺎﺭﻍ ﻳﺼﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻰ ‪ ٤‬ﺑﻮﺻﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﻗﻞ ﻟﻜﻞ ﺍﻟﺠﻮﺍﻧﺐ ﻟﻠﻤﺮﻭﺣﺔ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﺮﻛﻴﺐ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ‪.‬‬
‫‪١٢‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:07 PM‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻓﻲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻋﻼﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪ .‬ﺃﻳﻀﺎ ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﻡ ﺑﺒﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﻠﻴﺎﺕ ﺣﺴﺐ ﻋﻼﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺇﺫﺍ ﻟﻢ ﺗﻀﺒﻂ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻊ ﺷﻔﺮﺓ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻧﻚ‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ ﺍﻓﺘﺮﺍﺿﻴﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻣﺪﻯ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎﻝ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻓﻲ ﻣﺪﻯ ﺑﺤﻮﺍﻟﻲ ‪ 23‬ﻗﺪﻣﺎ )‪ 7‬ﺃﻣﺘﺎﺭ( ﺑﺨﻂ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺃﻳﻀﺎ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻠﻪ ﻓﻲ ﺯﺍﻭﻳﺔ ﺃﻓﻘﻴﺔ ﺣﺘﻰ ‪ 30‬ﺩﺭﺟﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺴﺘﺸﻌﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‪.‬‬
‫‪١٣‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 12-13‬‬
‫ﻭﺻﻒ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‬
‫‪١٨‬‬
‫‪٢٠‬‬
‫‪٢‬‬
‫‪٣‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ‬
‫‪٢١‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻹﺧﺮﺍﺝ‬
‫‪٤‬‬
‫ﺍﻷﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳﺔ )‪(9 ~ 0‬‬
‫‪٢٢‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻹﻟﻐﺎء‬
‫‪٥‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﺒﻘﻲ‬
‫‪٢٣‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﻗﻒ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﻗﺖ‬
‫‪٦‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﺨﻄﻮﺓ‬
‫ﺃﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺍﻟﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺒﻖ‪/‬ﺗﺨﻄﻲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻣﺞ‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫‪٩‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ‬
‫‪٧‬‬
‫‪٣‬‬
‫‪٨‬‬
‫‪٢٤‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪/‬ﺍﻟﺘﻮﻗﻒ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﻗﺖ‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ‬
‫‪٢٥‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺍﻟﻔﺔ‪/‬ﺍﻟﻘﻨﺎﺓ‬
‫‪٢٦‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﻢ‬
‫‪٢٧‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩﺓ‬
‫‪٢٢‬‬
‫‪٥‬‬
‫‪ ١٢‬ﺯﺭ ﺫﺍﻛﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺍﻟﻒ‪) SD ،‬ﺍﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﺳﻲ(‪/‬‬
‫‪) HD‬ﺍﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻟﻲ(‬
‫‪٢٨‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪/‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ‬
‫‪٢٩‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ‬
‫‪٢٣‬‬
‫‪٦‬‬
‫‪ ١٣‬ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻭﻡ‬
‫‪٣٠‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﺨﺮﻭﺝ‬
‫‪٧‬‬
‫‪ ١٤‬ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻱ‬
‫‪٣١‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ‬
‫‪ ١٥‬ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻡ‬
‫‪٣٢‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫‪ ١٦‬ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﻲء‪ ،‬ﺍﻷﺣﺎﺩﻱ‪/‬ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻴﺮﻳﻮ‬
‫‪٣٣‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺗﺄﺛﻴﺮ ‪PL II‬‬
‫‪٣٤‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ‪/DSP‬ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺍﺯﻥ‬
‫‪٣٥‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﺰ‬
‫‪٣٦‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﺘﺎﻡ‬
‫‪٢١‬‬
‫‪٤‬‬
‫‪ ١٠‬ﺯﺭ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ‬
‫ﺃﺯﺭﺍﺭ ‪PL II MODE‬‬
‫‪١١‬‬
‫‪٢٤‬‬
‫‪١٧‬‬
‫‪٢٥‬‬
‫‪٨‬‬
‫‪DVD‬‬
‫‪١٨‬‬
‫‪٢٦‬‬
‫‪٢٧‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ‪DVD‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺍﻟﻒ‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ‬
‫● ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‬
‫‪١٩‬‬
‫‪١‬‬
‫‪٢‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‬
‫‪٢٠‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪/‬ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‬
‫‪١‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ‪DVD‬‬
‫‪١٩‬‬
‫ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻔﺘﺤﺔ‬
‫‪٩‬‬
‫ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﻓﻲ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‪.‬‬
‫‪٢٨‬‬
‫‪٢٩‬‬
‫‪٣٠‬‬
‫‪١٠‬‬
‫‪٣١‬‬
‫‪١١‬‬
‫‪٣٢‬‬
‫‪١٢‬‬
‫‪٣٣‬‬
‫‪١٣‬‬
‫‪٣٤‬‬
‫‪١٤‬‬
‫‪١٥‬‬
‫‪٣٥‬‬
‫‪٣٦‬‬
‫‪١٤‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:08 PM‬‬
‫‪١٦‬‬
‫‪١٧‬‬
‫‪ ١‬ﻗﻢ ﺑﺈﺯﺍﻟﺔ ﻏﻄﺎء ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺔﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ ﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ‬
‫ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺑﺎﻟﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺍﻧﺰﻻﻗﻪ‬
‫ﺑﺎﺗﺠﺎﻩ ﺍﻟﺴﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ ٢‬ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﺑﻄﺎﺭﻳﺘﻴﻦ ﻣﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ‪ ،١٫٥V AAA‬ﻣﻊ ﺍﻻﻧﺘﺒﺎﻩ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻰ ﺻﺤﺔ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﻘﻀﺒﻴﻦ )‪ +‬ﻭ–(‪.‬‬
‫‪ ٣‬ﺃﻋﺪ ﻏﻄﺎء ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻰ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﻷﺻﻠﻲ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺗﺒﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻮﻃﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻟﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺗﺠﻨﺐ ﺗﺴﺮﺏ ﺃﻭ ﺗﺼﺪﻉ ﺍﻟﺨﻼﻳﺎ ‪:‬‬
‫‪‬‬
‫‪‬‬
‫‪‬‬
‫‪‬‬
‫ﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺎﺕ ﻓﻲ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻻﻧﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﻻﺗﺠﺎﻩ ﺍﻟﻘﻄﺒﻴﺔ ‪ (+) :‬ﻣﻊ )‪ (+‬ﻭ)‪ (-‬ﻣﻊ )‪.(-‬‬
‫ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺑﻄﺎﺭﻳﺎﺕ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ‪ .‬ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﺒﺪﻭ ﻣﺘﺸﺎﺑﻬﺔ ﻗﺪ ﺗﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻔﻮﻟﻄﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﻢ ﺩﺍﺋﻤﺎ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺒﺪﺍﻝ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺎﺕ ﻓﻲ ﻭﻗﺖ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻻ ﺗﻌﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺴﺨﻮﻧﺔ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺤﺮﺍﺭﺓ‪.‬‬
‫‪١٥‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 14-15‬‬
‫ﺟﺪﻭﻝ ﻛﻮﺩ ﻣﺎﺭﻛﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‬
‫ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺠﺰء ﻳﺸﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﻮﺳﺎﺋﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻌﺪﺩﺓ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﻜﻮﻧﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻴﺔ ﺍﻷﺧﺮﻯ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺒﻞ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺃﻭ ﺗﺮﻛﻴﺐ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ‪ ،‬ﺗﺎﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻄﻊ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﻓﺼﻞ ﺣﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺩ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺎﺭﻛﺔ‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:08 PM‬‬
‫‪44‬‬
‫‪45‬‬
‫‪46‬‬
‫‪47‬‬
‫‪48‬‬
‫‪49‬‬
‫‪50‬‬
‫‪51‬‬
‫‪52‬‬
‫‪53‬‬
‫‪54‬‬
‫‪55‬‬
‫‪56‬‬
‫‪57‬‬
‫‪58‬‬
‫‪59‬‬
‫‪60‬‬
‫‪61‬‬
‫‪62‬‬
‫‪63‬‬
‫‪64‬‬
‫‪65‬‬
‫‪66‬‬
‫‪67‬‬
‫‪68‬‬
‫‪69‬‬
‫‪70‬‬
‫‪71‬‬
‫‪72‬‬
‫‪73‬‬
‫‪74‬‬
‫‪75‬‬
‫‪76‬‬
‫‪77‬‬
‫‪78‬‬
‫‪79‬‬
‫‪80‬‬
‫‪81‬‬
‫‪82‬‬
‫‪83‬‬
‫‪84‬‬
‫‪85‬‬
‫‪86‬‬
‫‪56, 57, 58‬‬
‫‪01, 15‬‬
‫‪01, 02, 03, 04, 05, 06, 07, 08, 09, 10, 11,‬‬
‫‪12, 13, 14‬‬
‫‪AOC‬‬
‫‪01, 18, 40, 48‬‬
‫)‪Bell & Howell (M.Wards‬‬
‫‪57, 58, 81‬‬
‫‪Brocsonic‬‬
‫‪59, 60‬‬
‫‪Candle‬‬
‫‪18‬‬
‫‪Cetronic‬‬
‫‪03‬‬
‫‪Citizen‬‬
‫‪03, 18, 25‬‬
‫‪Cinema‬‬
‫‪97‬‬
‫‪Classic‬‬
‫‪03‬‬
‫‪Concerto‬‬
‫‪18‬‬
‫‪Contec‬‬
‫‪46‬‬
‫‪Coronado‬‬
‫‪15‬‬
‫‪Craig‬‬
‫‪03, 05, 61, 82, 83, 84‬‬
‫‪Croslex‬‬
‫‪62‬‬
‫‪Crown‬‬
‫‪03‬‬
‫‪Curtis Mates‬‬
‫‪59, 61, 63‬‬
‫‪CXC‬‬
‫‪03‬‬
‫‪Daewoo‬‬
‫‪02, 03, 04, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24,‬‬
‫‪25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 32, 34, 35, 36, 48, 59, 90‬‬
‫‪Daytron‬‬
‫‪40‬‬
‫‪Dynasty‬‬
‫‪03‬‬
‫‪Emerson‬‬
‫‪03, 15, 40, 46, 59, 61, 64, 82, 83, 84, 85‬‬
‫‪Fisher‬‬
‫‪19, 65‬‬
‫‪Funai‬‬
‫‪03‬‬
‫‪Futuretech‬‬
‫‪03‬‬
‫)‪General Electric (GE‬‬
‫‪06, 40, 56, 59, 66, 67, 68‬‬
‫‪Hall Mark‬‬
‫‪40‬‬
‫‪Hitachi‬‬
‫‪15, 18, 50, 59, 69‬‬
‫‪Inkel‬‬
‫‪45‬‬
‫‪JC Penny‬‬
‫‪56, 59, 67, 86‬‬
‫‪JVC‬‬
‫‪70‬‬
‫‪KTV‬‬
‫‪59, 61, 87, 88‬‬
‫‪KEC‬‬
‫‪03, 15, 40‬‬
‫‪KMC‬‬
‫‪15‬‬
‫)‪LG (Goldstar‬‬
‫‪01, 15, 16, 17, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44‬‬
‫‪Luxman‬‬
‫‪18‬‬
‫)‪LXI (Sears‬‬
‫‪19, 54, 56, 59, 60, 62, 63, 65, 71‬‬
‫‪Magnavox‬‬
‫‪15, 17, 18, 48, 54, 59, 60, 62, 72, 89‬‬
‫‪Marantz‬‬
‫‪40, 54‬‬
‫‪Matsui‬‬
‫‪54‬‬
‫‪MGA‬‬
‫‪18, 40‬‬
‫‪Mitsubishi/MGA‬‬
‫‪18, 40, 59, 60, 75‬‬
‫‪1‬‬
‫‪2‬‬
‫‪3‬‬
‫‪4‬‬
‫‪5‬‬
‫‪6‬‬
‫‪7‬‬
‫‪8‬‬
‫‪9‬‬
‫‪10‬‬
‫‪11‬‬
‫‪12‬‬
‫‪13‬‬
‫‪14‬‬
‫‪15‬‬
‫‪16‬‬
‫‪17‬‬
‫‪18‬‬
‫‪19‬‬
‫‪20‬‬
‫‪21‬‬
‫‪22‬‬
‫‪23‬‬
‫‪24‬‬
‫‪25‬‬
‫‪26‬‬
‫‪27‬‬
‫‪28‬‬
‫‪29‬‬
‫‪30‬‬
‫‪31‬‬
‫‪32‬‬
‫‪33‬‬
‫‪34‬‬
‫‪35‬‬
‫‪36‬‬
‫‪37‬‬
‫‪38‬‬
‫‪39‬‬
‫‪40‬‬
‫‪41‬‬
‫‪42‬‬
‫‪43‬‬
‫ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫● ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻼﺕ‬
‫‪18‬‬
‫‪18, 19, 20, 40, 59, 60‬‬
‫‪03‬‬
‫‪03‬‬
‫‪03‬‬
‫‪06, 07, 08, 09, 54, 66, 67, 73, 74‬‬
‫‪18‬‬
‫‪03, 15, 17, 18, 48, 54, 59, 62, 69, 90‬‬
‫‪15, 17, 18, 40, 48, 54, 62, 72‬‬
‫‪63, 66, 80, 91‬‬
‫‪15, 18, 59‬‬
‫‪40‬‬
‫‪06, 66, 67‬‬
‫‪17, 48, 56, 60, 61, 75‬‬
‫‪18, 59, 67, 76, 77, 78, 92, 93, 94‬‬
‫‪03, 19‬‬
‫‪40‬‬
‫‪00, 15, 16, 17, 40, 43, 46, 47, 48, 49,‬‬
‫‪59, 60, 98‬‬
‫‪Sanyo‬‬
‫‪19, 61, 65‬‬
‫‪Scott‬‬
‫‪03, 40, 60, 61‬‬
‫‪Sears‬‬
‫‪15, 18, 19‬‬
‫‪Sharp‬‬
‫‪15, 57, 64‬‬
‫)‪Signature 2000 (M.Wards‬‬
‫‪57, 58‬‬
‫‪Sony‬‬
‫‪50, 51, 52, 53, 55‬‬
‫‪Soundesign‬‬
‫‪03, 40‬‬
‫‪Spectricon‬‬
‫‪01‬‬
‫‪SSS‬‬
‫‪18‬‬
‫‪Sylvania‬‬
‫‪18, 40, 48, 54, 59, 60, 62‬‬
‫‪Symphonic‬‬
‫‪61, 95, 96‬‬
‫‪Tatung‬‬
‫‪06‬‬
‫‪Techwood‬‬
‫‪18‬‬
‫‪Teknika‬‬
‫‪03, 15, 18, 25‬‬
‫‪TMK‬‬
‫‪18, 40‬‬
‫‪Toshiba‬‬
‫‪19, 57, 63, 71‬‬
‫‪Vidtech‬‬
‫‪18‬‬
‫‪Videch‬‬
‫‪59, 60, 69‬‬
‫‪Wards‬‬
‫‪15, 17, 18, 40, 48, 54, 60, 64‬‬
‫‪Yamaha‬‬
‫‪18‬‬
‫‪York‬‬
‫‪40‬‬
‫‪Yupiteru‬‬
‫‪03‬‬
‫‪Zenith‬‬
‫‪58, 79‬‬
‫‪Zonda‬‬
‫‪01‬‬
‫‪Dongyang‬‬
‫‪03, 54‬‬
‫‪١٦‬‬
‫‪MTC‬‬
‫‪NEC‬‬
‫‪Nikei‬‬
‫‪Onking‬‬
‫‪Onwa‬‬
‫‪Panasonic‬‬
‫‪Penney‬‬
‫‪Philco‬‬
‫‪Philips‬‬
‫‪Pioneer‬‬
‫‪Portland‬‬
‫‪Proton‬‬
‫‪Quasar‬‬
‫‪Radio Shack‬‬
‫‪RCA/Proscan‬‬
‫‪Realistic‬‬
‫‪Sampo‬‬
‫‪Samsung‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺩ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺎﺭﻛﺔ‬
‫)‪Admiral (M.Wards‬‬
‫‪A Mark‬‬
‫‪Anam‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻢ‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻼﺕ‬
‫‪2,5 - 3 volte il formato del televisore‬‬
‫ﻣﻮﻗﻊ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ‬
‫ﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐّﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺎﻣﻞ ﺃﻭ ﺭﻑ ﺃﻭ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺣﺎﻣﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻤﺎﻉ‬
‫ﻳﺠﺐ ﺗﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻤﺎﻉ ﺑﺤﻮﺍﻟﻲ ‪ 2.5‬ﺃﻭ ‪ 3‬ﻣﺮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﻓﺔ ﺣﺠﻢ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻣﺜﻼ ‪ :‬ﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺑﺤﺠﻢ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ‪ 2.4 ~ 2 «32‬ﻣﺘﺮ )‪ 8 ~ 6‬ﺃﻗﺪﺍﻡ(‬
‫ﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺑﺤﺠﻢ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ‪ 4 ~ 3.5 «55‬ﻣﺘﺮ )‪ 13 ~ 11‬ﻗﺪﻣﺎ(‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻴﺔ ‪ei‬‬
‫ﺿﻊ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻴﺔ ﺃﻣﺎﻡ ﻣﻮﻗﻊ ﺍﺳﺘﻤﺎﻋﻚ‪ ،‬ﻣﻮﺟﻬﺔ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺧﻞ )ﺣﻮﺍﻟﻲ ‪ 45‬ﺩﺭﺟﺔ(‪.‬‬
‫ﺿﻊ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺑﻄﺮﻳﻘﺔ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﺭﺗﻔﺎﻉ ﻣﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺩﺩﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻟﻴﺔ ﻓﻲ ﻧﻔﺲ ﺍﻻﺭﺗﻔﺎﻉ ﺃﺫﻧﻴﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﺭﺗّﺐ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺟﻬﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻴﺔ ﻟﻤﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻪ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻲ ﻟﻤﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ ﺃﻭ ﺿﻌﻪ ﺃﻣﺎﻡ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ‪.‬‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ ‪g‬‬
‫ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﻬﻢ ﻧﺴﺒﻴﺎ‪ .‬ﺿﻌﻪ ﻓﻲ ﺃﻱ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﻛﻤﺎ ﺗﺮﻳﺪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ ‪f‬‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺃﻷﻓﻀﻞ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺮﻛﺒﻪ ﻓﻲ ﻧﻔﺲ ﺍﻻﺭﺗﻔﺎﻉ ﻣﻊ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻴﺔ‪ .‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺃﻳﻀﺎ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻀﻌﻪ ﻓﻮﻕ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺃﻭ ﺗﺤﺘﻪ ﻣﺒﺎﺷﺮﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ ‪hj‬‬
‫ﺿﻊ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ ﺧﻠﻒ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﺳﺘﻤﺎﻋﻚ‪ .‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻻ ﻳﻮﺟﺪ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﻛﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﺿﻊ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻫﺬﻩ ﻟﺘﺘﻮﺍﺟﻪ ﻣﻊ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺒﻌﺾ‪ .‬ﺿﻌﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺑﺤﻮﺍﻟﻲ ‪ 60‬ﺃﻭ‬
‫‪ 90‬ﺳﻢ )‪ 2‬ﺍﻟﻰ ‪ 3‬ﺃﻗﺪﺍﻡ( ﺃﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺫﻧﻴﻚ ﻭﻭﺍﺟﻬﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﺳﻔﻞ ﻗﻠﻴﻼ‪.‬‬
‫*‬
‫ﻋﻜﺲ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﺗﺴﺘﻌﻤﻞ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ ﻋﻤﻮﻣﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺎﻣﻞ ﻣﻊ ﺗﺄﺛﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻭﻻ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺇﺧﺮﺍﺝ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻓﻲ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻷﻭﻗﺎﺕ‪.‬‬
‫‪١٧‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 16-17‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻼﺕ‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻣﻀﺨﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ‬
‫ﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻳﺠﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺸﺘﺮﻱ ﻭﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ ﻭﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ‪ TX‬ﻣﻦ ﻭﻛﺎﻟﺔ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﺸﺘﺮﻱ ﻭﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ )‪(SWA-4000‬‬
‫ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺪﺍﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻑ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ ﻟﻤﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﻠﻚ ﺍﻷﺳﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻑ ﺍﻷﺳﻮﺩ )‪ (-‬ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻠﻚ ﺍﻷﺣﻤﺮ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻑ ﺍﻷﺣﻤﺮ )‪ ،(+‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﺣﺮﺭ ﺍﻟﺴﺪﺍﺩﺓ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺻﻞ ﻗﺎﺑﺲ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ ﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺃﻟﻮﺍﻥ ﺃﻃﺮﺍﻑ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺗﻼﻡ ﺃﻟﻮﻥ ﻗﺎﺑﺴﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﺃﺣﻤﺮ‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻲ )ﻳﻤﻴﻦ(‬
‫● ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻼﺕ‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻲ )ﻳﺴﺎﺭ(‬
‫ﺃﺳﻮﺩ‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻲ )ﻳﺴﺎﺭ(‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻲ )ﻳﻤﻴﻦ(‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻲ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻲ )ﻳﻤﻴﻦ(‬
‫)ﻳﺴﺎﺭ(‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺻﻞ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻳﺔ ﻭﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻣﺸﻐّﻞ ‪ ،DVD‬ﻭﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﺻﻔﺤﺘﻴﻦ ‪.١٨‬‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﻋﻨﺪ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ ﻣﺸﻐّﻞ ‪ ،DVD‬ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ‪ TX‬ﺍﻟﻰ ﻓﺘﺤﺔ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ‪) TX‬ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ(‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ ﻟﻠﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﺳﻤﻚ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ‪ TX‬ﻟﻜﻲ ﻳﺘﺠﻪ ﺍﻟﺠﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺤﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻴﻦ ﻭﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻔﺘﺤﺔ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺍﻻﺗﺼﺎﻻﺕ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ‪.TX‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺻﻞ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻴﺴﺮﻯ ﻭﺍﻟﻴﻤﻨﻰ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺻﻞ ﺣﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ ﻓﻲ ﻣﺨﺮﺝ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭﻱ ﻭﻗﻢ ﺑﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻣﻔﺘﺎﺡ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻲ )ﻳﺴﺎﺭ(‬
‫ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ‪TX‬‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻲ )ﻳﻤﻴﻦ(‬
‫ﻳﺘﺠﻪ ﺍﻟﺠﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺤﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻴﺴﺎﺭ‬
‫‪J‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻻ ﺗﺘﺮﻙ ﺍﻷﻃﻔﺎﻝ ﻳﻠﻌﺒﻮﻥ ﺑﻤﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺃﻭ ﻓﻲ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﻗﺮﻳﺐ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ .‬ﻗﺪ ﻳﺼﻴﺒﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﻟﺠﺮﺡ ﺍﺫﺍ ﺳﻘﻄﺖ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺃﺳﻼﻙ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‪ ،‬ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﻄﺒﻴﺔ )‪ (-/+‬ﺻﺤﻴﺤﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺿﻊ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ ﻟﻤﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺩﺩﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻔﻴﻀﺔ ﻓﻲ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﻻ ﻳﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﻷﻃﻔﺎﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺗﺠﻨﺐ ﺇﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﺃﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻷﺷﻴﺎء‬
‫ﺍﻟﻐﺮﻳﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻣﺠﺮﻱ )ﺛﻘﺐ( ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ ﻟﻤﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺩﺩﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻔﻴﻀﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻻ ﺗﻌﻠﻖ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺠﺮﻱ )ﺍﻟﺜﻘﺐ(‪.‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪١٨‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:09 PM‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻭﺿﻌﺖ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻓﻲ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﻗﺮﻳﺐ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻮﻳﻪ ﻟﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﺑﺴﺒﺐ ﺍﻟﻤﺠﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻤﻐﻨﻄﻴﺴﻲ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺗﺞ ﻋﻦ‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‪ .‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﺣﺪﺙ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﺿﻊ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺑﻌﻴﺪﺍ ﻋﻦ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫‪١٩‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 18-19‬‬
‫‪J‬‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻼﺕ‬
‫ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ‪ VIDEO OUT‬ﺍﻟﻰ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻧﻚ‬
‫ﺍﺧﺘﺮ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻕ ﺍﻷﺭﺑﻊ ﻟﻠﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺿﻊ ﻭﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ ﻓﻲ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﺧﻠﻒ ﻣﻮﻗﻊ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻤﺎﻉ‪ .‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻭﺣﺪﺓ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ ﻗﺮﻳﺒﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ ﻟﻠﻐﺎﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﻳﺤﺪﺙ ﺍﻟﻘﻄﻊ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺗﻲ‬
‫ﺑﺴﺒﺐ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻮﺵ‪.‬‬
‫● ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻼﺕ‬
‫‪ ‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻣﺖ ﺟﻬﺎﺯﺍ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻓﺮﻥ ﺍﻟﻤﻴﻜﺮﻭﻭﻳﻒ‪ ،‬ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ‪ LAN‬ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ‪ ،‬ﻣﻌﺪﺍﺕ‬
‫ﺑﻠﻮﺗﻮﺙ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﺃﻱ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻳﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻧﻔﺲ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺩﺩ )‪ 5.8‬ﻏﻴﻐﺎﻫﺮﺗﺰ( ﻓﻲ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻗﺮﻳﺐ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﻳﺤﺪﺙ ﺍﻟﻘﻄﻊ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺗﻲ ﺑﺴﺒﺐ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻮﺵ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻣﺴﺎﻓﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﻘﻞ ﻟﻤﻮﺟﺔ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺩﻳﻮ ﻫﻲ ‪ 33‬ﻗﺪﻣﺎ )‪ 10‬ﺃﻣﺘﺎﺭ( ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎ‪ ،‬ﻟﻜﻨﻬﺎ ﻗﺪ ﺗﺨﺘﻠﻒ‬
‫ﺍﻋﺘﻤﺎﺩﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻴﺌﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪ .‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻔﻮﻻﺫﻱ ‪ -‬ﺍﻻﺳﻤﻨﺘﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻌﺪﻧﻲ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ ﻭﻭﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻷﻥ ﻣﻮﺟﺔ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺩﻳﻮ ﻻ ﺗﺨﺘﺮﻕ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﺪﻥ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ )‪ (HT-XA100/XA100C‬ﻣﺘﻄﺎﺑﻖ ﻣﻊ ﻭﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ ‪.SWA-3000‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫ﻃﺮﻳﻘﺔ ‪1‬‬
‫)ﻣﺰﻭﺩ ﺑﻬﺎ(‬
‫‪ ‬ﻻ ﺗﺪﺧﻞ ﺃﻱ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺜﻨﺎء ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ‪ TX‬ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺻﺔ ﺑﻬﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ‪ .‬ﻗﺪ ﻳﺆﺫﻱ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ ﺃﻭ ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﺗﺘﻢ ﺇﺯﺍﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺑﺴﻬﻮﻟﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻃﺮﻳﻘﺔ ‪2‬‬
‫ﻃﺮﻳﻘﺔ ‪3‬‬
‫)ﻣﺰﻭﺩ ﺑﻬﺎ(‬
‫‪ ‬ﻻ ﺗﺪﺧﻞ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ‪ TX‬ﺭﺃﺳﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﻘﺐ ﺃﻭ ﺑﺎﻻﺗﺠﺎﻩ ﺍﻟﻌﻜﺴﻲ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ‪ TX‬ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﺘﻮﻗﻒ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ‪ .‬ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﺪﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﻳﺴﺒﺐ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﺸﻜﻠﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﺗﻢ ﺇﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ‪ TX‬ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻻ ﺗﺨﺮﺝ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ ﺍﻷﺻﻮﺍﺕ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻫﻮﺍﺋﻲ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻘﺒﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ ﻣﺒﻴﺖ ﻓﻲ ﻭﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ‪ .‬ﺍﺣﻔﻆ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺑﻌﻴﺪﺍ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻤﺎء ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻃﻮﺑﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻷﻓﻀﻞ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻤﺎﻉ‪ ،‬ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﻄﻘﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺠﺎﻭﺭﺓ ﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ ﻧﻈﻴﻔﺔ ﺩﻭﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺍﺋﻖ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻟﻢ ﻳﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻊ ﻋﻠﻰ ‪ DVD 5.1-CH‬ﺃﻭ ‪Dolby Pro Logic‬‬
‫‪.II‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪ ،2-CH‬ﻻ ﻳﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻃﺮﻳﻘﺔ ‪) HDMI : 1‬ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭﻱ(‬
‫ﺻﻞ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ‪) HDMI‬ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭﻱ( ﻣﻦ ﻣﻘﺒﺲ ‪ HDMI OUT‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ ﻟﻤﺸﻐّﻞ ‪ DVD‬ﺍﻟﻰ ﻣﻘﺒﺲ ‪ HDMI IN‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻧﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻃﺮﻳﻘﺔ ‪ : 2‬ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﻤﻜﻮﻥ‬
‫ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻧﻚ ﻣﺠﻬﺰﺍ ﺑﻤﺪﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﻤﻜﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﺻﻞ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﻤﻜﻮﻥ )ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺰﻭﺩ ﺑﻬﺎ( ﻣﻦ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﺲ ﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﻤﻜﻮﻥ )‪ Pr، Pb‬ﻭ‪ (Y‬ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ ﻟﻤﺸﻐّﻞ ‪ DVD‬ﺍﻟﻰ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﺲ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﻤﻜﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻧﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻃﺮﻳﻘﺔ ‪ : 3‬ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺐ‬
‫ﺻﻞ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﻤﺰﻭﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻘﺒﺲ ‪ VIDEO OUT‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ ﻟﻤﺸﻐّﻞ ‪ DVD‬ﺍﻟﻰ ﻣﻘﺒﺲ ‪ VIDEO IN‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻧﻚ‪.‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺢ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﺸﺎﺑﻚ )‪ (576i، 480i‬ﻟﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﻤﻜﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻣﺖ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ‪ HDMI‬ﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻣﺸﻐّﻞ ‪ ،DVD‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺸﻐّﻞ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ‬
‫ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺑﻊ ﻟﻠﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪ .‬ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻓﻲ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ ﻓﻘﻂ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﺪﻋﻢ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ) ‪.Anynet+ (HDMI-CEC‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻳﺮﺟﻰ ﻓﺤﺺ ﺭﻣﺰ‬
‫‪٢٠‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:09 PM‬‬
‫)ﺍﺫﺍ ﻭﺟﺪ ﺭﻣﺰ‬
‫ﻓﻲ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻧﻚ‪ ،‬ﻳﺪﻋﻢ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪.(+Anynet‬‬
‫‪٢١‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 20-21‬‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻼﺕ‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪) HDMI‬ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭﻱ(‬
‫ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺩﺭﺟﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻮﺡ‬
‫ﺗﺴﻤﺢ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻟﻠﻤﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﺑﺎﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺩﺭﺟﺔ ﻭﺿﻮﺡ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﻟﺨﺮﺝ ‪.HDMI‬‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻛﺸﻒ ‪ HDMI‬ﺍﻵﻟﻲ )ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭﻱ(‬
‫ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﺤﻮﻝ ﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻟﻠﻤﺸﻐّﻞ ﺁﻟﻴﺎ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪ HDMI‬ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ‪ HDMI‬ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻭﺻﻒ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ‪HDMI‬‬
‫ﻃﺮﻑ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ‪ – HDMI‬ﻳﺪﻋﻢ ﺑﻴﺎﻧﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ‬
‫ ﺗﺨﺮﺝ ‪ HDMI‬ﺍﻹﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﻟﺼﺔ ﻓﻘﻂ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬‫ ﺍﺫﺍ ﻟﻢ ﻳﺪﻋﻢ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻧﻚ ‪) HDCP‬ﺣﻤﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﺘﻮﻳﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ ﻓﻲ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻨﻄﺎﻕ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺩﺩﻱ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻟﻲ(‪ ،‬ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻮﻳﻪ ﺍﻟﻌﺸﻮﺍﺋﻲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ‪.‬‬‫• ﻟﻤﺎﺫﺍ ﺗﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﺷﺮﻛﺔ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ ‪ HDMI‬؟‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺍﻷﻧﺎﻟﻮﺟﻲ ﻳﻄﻠﺐ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ‪/‬ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻷﻧﺎﻟﻮﺟﻴﺔ‪ .‬ﻟﻜﻦ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ‪ ،BD/DVD‬ﺍﻟﺒﻴﻴﺎﻧﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﻘﻮﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺭﻗﻤﻴﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻟﺬﻟﻚ ﻳﺤﺘﺎﺝ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻣﺤﻮﻝ‬
‫ﺍﻹﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻷﻧﺎﻟﻮﺟﻴﺔ )ﻓﻲ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ ﺑﻠﻮ – ﺭﺍﻱ( ﻭﻣﺤﻮﻝ ﺍﻹﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻷﻧﺎﻟﻮﺟﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ )ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ(‪ .‬ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻮﻳﻞ‪ ،‬ﺗﺨﻔﺾ‬
‫ﻧﻮﻋﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺑﺴﺒﺐ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻮﻳﻪ ﻭﻓﻘﺪﺍﻥ ﺍﻹﺷﺎﺭﺓ‪ .‬ﺗﻘﻨﻴﺔ ‪ HDMI‬ﻣﻤﺘﺎﺯﺓ ﻷﻧﻬﺎ ﻻ ﺗﺤﺘﺎﺝ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺇﺟﺮﺍء ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻮﻳﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻹﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ‪/‬ﺍﻷﻧﺎﻟﻮﺟﻴﺔ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺭﻗﻤﻴﺔ ﺧﺎﻟﺼﺔ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐّﻞ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻧﻚ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻣﺎ ﻫﻲ ‪ HDCP‬؟‬
‫‪) HDCP‬ﺣﻤﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﺘﻮﻳﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ ﻓﻲ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻨﻄﺎﻕ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺩﺩﻱ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻟﻲ( ﻫﻲ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﻟﺤﻤﺎﻳﺔ ﻣﺤﺘﻮﻳﺎﺕ ‪ BD/DVD‬ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺮﻭﺟﺔ ﺑﻮﺍﺳﻄﺔ ‪ HDMI‬ﻣﻦ ﻧﺴﺨﻬﺎ‪ .‬ﺗﺰﻭﺩ‬
‫ﺑﺎﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ ﺍﻵﻣﻦ ﺑﻴﻦ ﻣﺼﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ )‪ ،PC، DVD‬ﻭﻏﻴﺮﻫﺎ( ﻭﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ )ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻹﺳﻘﺎﻁ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﻴﺮﻫﺎ(‪ .‬ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻔﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﺘﻮﻳﺎﺕ ﻓﻲ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺼﺪﺭ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺗﺠﻨﺐ ﻧﺴﺨﻬﺎ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﺘﻤﺪﺓ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻣﺎ ﻫﻲ ‪ + Anynet‬؟‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪ + Anynet‬ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻣﺮﻳﺤﺔ ﺗﻘﺪﻡ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺻﻮﻝ ﻟﻬﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺑﻮﺍﺳﻄﺔ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ ﻣﻊ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪.+ Anynet‬‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ‪ ،‬ﻳﺪﻋﻢ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﺰﻓﻮﻳﻦ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪.+ Anynet‬‬
‫ ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺭﻣﺰ‬‫ ﺍﺫﺍ ﻗﻤﺖ ﺑﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐّﻞ ﻭﺇﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺒﺪﺃ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐّﻞ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺁﻟﻴﺎ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺤﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪.HDMI‬‬‫‪ -‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻗﻤﺖ ﺑﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐّﻞ ﻭﺿﻐﻄﺖ ﺯﺭ ‪) Play‬ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ( ﺑﻌﺪ ﺇﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻓﻮﺭﺍ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺤﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪.HDMI‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻟﻢ ﻳﺪﻋﻢ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺩﺭﺟﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻜﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻟﻦ ﺗﺴﺘﻄﻴﻊ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ‬
‫ﺑﺸﻜﻞ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ‪ ،HDMI‬ﻻ ﺗﺨﺮﺝ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﻤﻜﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺍﻧﻈﺮ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻟﻠﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻟﻠﺤﺼﻮﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﺣﻮﻝ ﻛﻴﻔﻴﺔ‬
‫ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﺼﺪﺭ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻟﻠﺘﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫● ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻼﺕ‬
‫• ‪) HDMI‬ﺑﻴﻨﻴﺔ ﺗﻮﺍﺻﻞ ﺍﻟﻮﺳﻂ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻌﺪﺩﺓ ﺑﺎﻟﻮﺿﻮﺡ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻟﻲ(‬
‫‪ HDMI‬ﻫﯽ ﺑﻴﻨﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺍﺻﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺑﻬﺎ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﻴﺎﻧﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻃﺮﻑ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺪ ﻓﻘﻂ‪ .‬ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ‪ ،HDMI‬ﻳﻨﻘﻞ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ ﺑﻠﻮ –‬
‫ﺭﺍﻱ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ ﻭﻳﻘﺪﻡ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﺤﻴﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺫﺍﺕ ﻣﻘﺒﺲ ﺩﺧﻞ ‪.HDMI‬‬
‫ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻭﺍﻣﺴﻚ ﺯﺭ ‪) SD/HD‬ﺍﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﺳﻲ‪/‬ﺍﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻟﻲ(‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺩﺭﺟﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻮﻓﺮﺓ ﻟﺨﺮﺝ ‪HDMI‬‬
‫ﻫﻲ‪.576p (480p) ، 720p، 1080i/1080p‬‬
‫• ﺩﺭﺟﺔ ﻭﺿﻮﺡ ‪) SD‬ﺍﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﺳﻲ( ﻫﻲ) ‪ 576p (480p‬ﻭﺩﺭﺟﺔ ﻭﺿﻮﺡ ‪HD‬‬
‫)ﺍﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻟﻲ( ﻫﻲ ‪.720p، 108i/1080p‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻘﻴﻤﺔ ﺍﻻﻓﺘﺮﺍﺿﻴﺔ ﻫﻲ) ‪.576P (480P‬‬
‫ﻟﻤﺎﺫﺍ ﻳﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ‪) HDMI‬ﺑﻴﻨﻴﺔ ﺗﻮﺍﺻﻞ ﺍﻟﻮﺳﻂ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻌﺪﺩﺓ‬
‫ﺑﺎﻟﻮﺿﻮﺡ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻟﻲ( ؟‬
‫ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﻳﻨﻘﻞ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻟـ ‪ DVD‬ﺭﻗﻤﻴﺎ‬
‫ﺩﻭﻥ ﺇﺟﺮﺍءﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻮﻳﻞ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻷﻧﺎﻟﻮﺝ‪ .‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﺴﺘﻤﺘﻊ‬
‫ﺑﺄﺿﻮﺡ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻋﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ‪.HDMI‬‬
‫ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ) ‪Anynet+ (HDMI-CEC‬‬
‫‪ +Anynet‬ﻫﻲ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺑﻬﺎ ﺗﺤﻜﻢ ﺃﺟﻬﺰﺓ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ ﺍﻷﺧﺮﻯ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺑﻊ ﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ‪ .‬ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ‪+Anynet .‬‬
‫ﻋﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﺝ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ‪ .HDMI‬ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻣﺘﻮﻓﺮﺓ ﻓﻲ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﺪﻋﻢ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ‬
‫‪.+Anynet‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺻﻞ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ ﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ‪) .HDMI‬ﺍﻧﻈﺮ ﺻﻔﺤﺔ ‪(٢١‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﺒﻂ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪ +Anynet‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻧﻚ‪) .‬ﺍﻧﻈﺮ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺗﻌﻠﻴﻤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻷﻛﺜﺮ‬
‫ﻣﻊ ‪+Anynet‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ‪(.‬‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺑﻊ ﻟﻠﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪ .‬ﻓﻲ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻧﻚ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﻠﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺑﻊ ﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‬
‫‪ T، S ،‬ﻭ ‪W,X‬‬
‫‪،‬‬
‫‪،‬‬
‫‪،‬‬
‫)ﺃﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻮﻓﺮﺓ ‪ :‬ﺃﺯﺭﺍﺭ‬
‫ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ‪.‬‬
‫‪( ،‬‬
‫ﺍﺫﺍ ﺍﺧﺘﺮﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‬
‫ﺍﺿﺒﻂ) ‪ Anynet+ (HDMI-CEC‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ‪ On‬ﻋﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺍﻟﻀﻐﻂ ﺯﺭ ‪ +Anynet‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺑﻊ ﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻧﻚ‪.‬‬
‫• ‪ : Receiver : On‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻤﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻼﻝ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ‪.‬‬
‫• ‪ : Receiver : Off‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻤﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻼﻝ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺫﺍ ﺍﺧﺘﺮﺕ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ‬
‫ﺍﺧﺘﺮ ‪ THEATER to connector‬ﻭﺍﺿﺒﻂ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺍﺩ ﺃﺩﻧﺎﻩ‪.‬‬
‫• ‪ : View TV‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﺿﺒﻄﺖ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ) ‪ Anynet+ (HDMI-CEC‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻭﺍﺧﺘﺮﺕ‬
‫‪) View TV‬ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ(‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﺤﻮﻝ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ‪.‬‬
‫• ‪ : THEATER Menu‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ‪.‬‬
‫• ‪ : THEATER Operation‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻗﺮﺹ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ‪ .‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺗﺤﻮﻳﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﻔﺼﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ‪.‬‬
‫• ‪ : Receiver : On‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻤﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻼﻝ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ‪.‬‬
‫• ‪ : Receiver : Off‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻤﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻼﻝ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪٢٢‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:10 PM‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﺴﺘﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻋﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﺑﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﺼﺮﻱ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺻﻮﻝ ﻓﻘﻂ‪.‬‬
‫‪٢٣‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 22-23‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﺼﺮﻱ ‪ :‬ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻼﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ ‪ : 2‬ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ‬
‫ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻤﻜﻮﻧﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻴﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ ‪ : 1‬ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻷﻧﺎﻟﻮﺟﻲ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻲ ‪ /‬ﻣﺸﻐّﻞ ‪MP3‬‬
‫ﻣﻜﻮﻧﺎﺕ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻣﺸﻐّﻞ ‪MP3‬‬
‫● ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻼﺕ‬
‫ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻌﻲ )ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺰﻭﺩ ﺑﻪ(‬
‫ﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﺪﻯ ﻣﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻷﻧﺎﻟﻮﺝ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻲ ﺳﻤﻌﻲ‬
‫ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ‪ ،Audio Out‬ﺻﻠﻪ ﺇﻣﺎ ﻣﻊ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻴﺴﺎﺭ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻴﻦ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ‬
‫)ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺰﻭﺩ ﺑﻪ(‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻲ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻷﻧﺎﻟﻮﺟﻲ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻲ‬
‫ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ ‪ : 2‬ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻹﻧﺎﻟﻮﺟﻲ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻲ‬
‫ﻣﻜﻮﻧﺎﺕ ﺍﻹﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻷﻧﺎﻟﻮﺟﻴﺔ ﻣﺜﻞ ‪) VCR‬ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ(‬
‫ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻌﻲ‬
‫)ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺰﻭﺩ ﺑﻪ(‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺻﻞ ‪) AUX IN 2‬ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪ Audio Out‬ﻟﻠﻤﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻷﻧﺎﻟﻮﺟﻲ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻲ‬
‫• ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻼﺋﻤﺔ ﺃﻟﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻠﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪Audio OUT‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺻﻞ ‪) AUX IN‬ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪ Audio Out‬ﻟﻠﻤﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻷﻧﺎﻟﻮﺟﻲ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻲ ‪ /‬ﻣﺸﻐّﻞ ‪.MP3‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) AUX‬ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺩﺧﻞ ‪.AUX1‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﻟﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﺯﺭ ‪) FUNCTION‬ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻳﺘﺤﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻊ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﻠﻲ‬
‫‪.DVD/CD Œ DIGITAL IN Œ AUX 1 Œ AUX 2 Œ USB Œ FM‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) AUX‬ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺩﺧﻞ ‪.AUX2‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺃﻳﻀﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪) FUNCTION‬ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻳﺘﺤﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻊ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﻠﻲ‬
‫‪.DVD/CD Œ DIGITAL IN Œ AUX 1 Œ AUX 2 Œ USB Œ FM‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻗﺎﺑﺲ ‪ Video Output‬ﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺹ ﺑﻚ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻞ ﻗﺎﺑﺲ ‪ Audio Output‬ﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﻮﺝ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﺼﺮﻱ ‪ :‬ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻲ‬
‫ﻣﻜﻮﻧﺎﺕ ﺍﻹﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺻﻨﺪﻭﻕ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﺑﻞ‪/‬ﻣﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺎﻋﻲ )‪ : Set-Top Box‬ﺳﻴﺖ – ﺗﻮﺏ ﺑﺎﻛﺲ(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺻﻞ ‪) Digital Input‬ﺍﻟﺒﺼﺮﻱ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪ Digital Output‬ﻟﻠﻤﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻲ‪.‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪٢٤‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:11 PM‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﻭﺗﻮﺻﻞ ﻣﺸﻐّﻞ ‪ ،iPod MP3‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﺸﺤﻦ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺑﻄﺎﺭﻳﺔ ‪.iPod‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) AUX‬ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ‪.DIGITAL IN‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺃﻳﻀﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺯﺭ ‪) FUNCTION‬ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻳﺘﺤﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻊ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﻠﻲ‬
‫‪.DVD/CD Œ DIGITAL IN Œ AUX 1 Œ AUX 2 Œ USB Œ FM‬‬
‫‪٢٥‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 24-25‬‬
‫ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻫﻮﺍﺋﻲ ‪FM‬‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺑﻊ ﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ ‪ DVD‬ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ‪.‬‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻼﺕ‬
‫ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺻﻞ ﺣﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﻳﺔ ﻟﻠﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻣﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻨﺎﻭﺏ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺻﻞ ﻫﻮﺍﺋﻲ ‪ FM‬ﺍﻟﻤﺰﻭﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻃﺮﻑ »‪.«Ω COAXIAL ٧٥ FM‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﻗﻢ ﺑﻨﻘﻞ ﺳﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻬﻮﺍﺋﻲ ﺑﺒﻂء ﺣﺘﻰ ﺗﺒﺤﺚ ﻋﻦ ﻣﻮﻗﻊ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻘﺒﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺤﺴﻦ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺛﺒّﺘﻪ ﻓﻲ ﺟﺪﺍﺭ ﺃﻭ ﺳﻄﺢ ﺛﺎﺑﺖ ﺁﺧﺮ‪.‬‬
‫● ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ‬
‫ﻫﻮﺍﺋﻲ ‪FM‬‬
‫)ﻣﺰﻭﺩ ﺑﻪ(‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) DVD RECEIVER‬ﻣﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ‪ (DVD‬ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ ‪.DVD‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) FUNCTION‬ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪ DVD‬ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ‪.DVD/CD‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻻ ﺗﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺑﺚ ‪.AM‬‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) TV‬ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ( ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺿﻊ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٥‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) POWER‬ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ( ﻣﻨﺄﺟﻞ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ‬
‫ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻫﺬﺍ‪.‬‬
‫ﻣﺮﻭﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺒﺮﻳﺪ‬
‫‪VIDEO‬‬
‫‪ .٦‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ TV/VIDEO‬ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻧﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﺗﺰﻭﺩ ﻣﺮﻭﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺒﺮﻳﺪ ﺑﺎﻟﻬﻮﺍء ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺭﺩ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺗﺠﻨﺐ ﺍﻟﺘﺴﺨﻴﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﺍﺋﺪ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺮﺟﺎء ﺇﺗﺒﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻮﻃﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻟﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺳﻼﻣﺘﻚ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻬﻮﻳﺌﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺟﻴﺪﺓ‪ .‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻟﻢ ﺗﻜﻦ ﺗﻬﻮﻳﺌﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺟﻴﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﻳﺴﺒﺐ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺭﺗﻔﺎﻉ ﺩﺭﺟﺔ ﺍﻟﺤﺮﺍﺭﺓ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﻭﻳﺴﻔﺮ ﻋﻦ ﺧﻠﻞ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻻ ﺗﺤﺠﺐ ﻣﺮﻭﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺒﺮﻳﺪ ﺃﻭ ﻓﺘﺤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻬﻮﻳﺌﺔ‪) .‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﺗﻢ ﺣﺠﺐ ﻣﺮﻭﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺒﺮﻳﺪ ﻭﻓﺘﺤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻬﻮﻳﺌﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺠﺮﻳﺪﺓ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺎﺵ‪ ،‬ﺗﺮﺗﻔﻊ ﺩﺭﺟﺔ ﺍﻟﺤﺮﺍﺭﺓ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﻭﻳﺴﺒﺐ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺤﺮﻳﻖ‪(.‬‬
‫‪٢٦‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:11 PM‬‬
‫‪٢٧‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 26-27‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ‪MP3/WMA-CD‬‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺎﻧﺎﺕ )‪ (CD-R، CD-RW‬ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻔﺮﺓ ﺑﺘﺼﻤﻴﻢ ‪.MP3/WMA‬‬
‫ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‬
‫‪A‬‬
‫‪B‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺃﻏﻠﻖ ﺍﻟﺤﺠﻴﺮﺓ ﻋﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺍﻟﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) PLAY‬ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ( )‬
‫• ﻳﺒﺪﺃ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺃﻭﺗﻮﻣﺎﺗﻴﻜﻴﺎ‪.‬‬
‫(‬
‫● ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﻋﻤﻮﺩﻳﺎ ﻓﻲ ﺛﻘﺐ ﺃﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺿﻊ ﻗﺮﺻﺎ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺼﻴﻨﻴﺔ ﻣﻊ ﻣﺮﺍﻋﺎﺓ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺘﺮﻙ ﺍﻟﻌﻼﻣﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺃﻋﻠﻰ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺿﻊ ﻗﺮﺹ ‪ MP3/WMA‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﻴﻨﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ‪ MP3/WMA‬ﻭﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺒﺪﺃ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺷﻜﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﻳﻌﺘﻤﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺮﺹ ‪.MP3/WMA‬‬
‫• ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻣﻠﻔﺎﺕ ‪.WMA-DRM‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ S,T,W,X‬ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻷﻟﺒﻮﻣﻦ ﻭﺑﻌﺪ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪S,T‬ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺎﺭ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﻟﺘﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﻷﻟﺒﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ S,T,W,X‬ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻷﻟﺒﻮﻡ ﺍﻵﺧﺮ ﻓﻲ‬
‫ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) STOP‬ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ( )‪ (‬ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫ﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) STOP‬ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ( )‪ (‬ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﻣﺮﺓ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ‪) PRESS PLAY‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ( ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺨﺰﻥ ﻣﻮﻗﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺬﺍﻛﺮﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) PLAY‬ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ( ) ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪ ،‬ﻳﺴﺘﺄﻧﻒ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻮﻗﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪) .‬ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻣﻊ‬
‫ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ DVD‬ﻓﻘﻂ‪(.‬‬
‫• ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﻣﺮﺗﻴﻦ‪ ،‬ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ‪) STOP‬ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ(‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) PLAY‬ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ( ) (‪ ،‬ﻳﺒﺪﺃ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺍﻳﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻟﺘﻮﻗﻒ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻣﺆﻗﺘﺎ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) PAUSE‬ﺍﻟﺘﻮﻗﻒ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﻗﺖ() ( ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻻﺳﺘﺌﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) PLAY‬ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ()‬
‫‪ ‬ﺍﻋﺘﻤﺎﺩﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﺴﺠﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪.MP3/WMA-CD‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺗﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﺘﻮﻳﺎﺕ ﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﻣﺪﻣﺞ ‪ MP3‬ﻃﺒﻘﺎ ﻟﺘﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﻣﺴﺎﺭ ‪ MP3WMA‬ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺠﻠﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪.‬‬
‫ﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻳﻘﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻒ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ‬
‫• ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪S,T,W,X‬ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ ﻭﺍﺧﺘﺮ ﺍﻻﻳﻘﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻏﻮﺏ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺠﺰء ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻱ ﻟﻠﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ‪.‬‬
‫(‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻳﻘﻮﻥ ﻣﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺳﻴﻘﻰ ‪ :‬ﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻣﻠﻔﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺳﻴﻘﻰ ﻓﻘﻂ‪ ،‬ﺍﺧﺘﺮ ﺍﻳﻘﻮﻥ‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺍﻋﺘﻤﺎﺩﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺤﺘﻮﻳﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﻟﻴﺔ ﺑﺸﻜﻞ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻳﻘﻮﻥ ﻣﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ‪ :‬ﻟﻤﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﻣﻠﻔﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﻓﻘﻂ‪ ،‬ﺍﺧﺘﺮ ﺍﻳﻘﻮﻥ‬
‫‪ ‬ﻟﻦ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺻﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻓﻲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐّﻞ ﻷﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻳﺨﺎﻟﻒ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﺎﺕ) ‪ : CSS (Content Scrambling System‬ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺣﻤﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺦ‬
‫ﺍﻳﻘﻮﻥ ﻣﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﻠﻢ ‪ :‬ﻟﻤﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﻣﻠﻔﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﻠﻢ ﻓﻘﻂ‪ ،‬ﺍﺧﺘﺮ ﺍﻳﻘﻮﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻳﻘﻮﻥ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻒ ‪ :‬ﻟﻤﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻔﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﺍﺧﺘﺮ ﺍﻳﻘﻮﻥ‬
‫‪٢٨‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:12 PM‬‬
‫‪.‬‬
‫‪.‬‬
‫‪.‬‬
‫‪.‬‬
‫‪٢٩‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 28-29‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ‪DIVX‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻮﻇﺎﺋﻒ ﻓﻲ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺤﺔ ﺗﻄﺒﻖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻗﺮﺹ ‪.DivX‬‬
‫ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻣﻠﻒ ‪JPEG‬‬
‫‪D‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺨﻄﻲ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻡ‪/‬ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻒ‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﺨﺰﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺭﺩﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻣﻴﺮﺍ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ ﺃﻭ ﻣﺴﺠﻞ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﻨﻘﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﻣﻠﻔﺎﺕ ‪ JPEG‬ﻓﻲ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻜﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻣﺞ ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻠﻬﺎ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ‬
‫ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﺭﺍﻥ‪/‬ﺍﻻﻧﻘﻼﺏ‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪S,T,W,X‬ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫● ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫‪G‬‬
‫ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪.# ،$‬‬
‫• ﺍﺭﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻟﻲ ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ ، $‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻛﺒﺮ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻔﻴﻦ‬
‫ﻓﻴﺎﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﺭﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻖ ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ ،$‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻛﺒﺮ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻔﻴﻦ‬
‫ﻓﻴﺎﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪.‬‬
‫‪D‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﻳﻊ‬
‫ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪.  ، ‬‬
‫ﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻒ ﺑﺴﺮﻋﺔ ﺃﺳﺮﻉ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ ‬ﺃﻭ ‪‬ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻱ ﺯﺭ ﻣﻨﻬﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﺳﺮﻋﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﻠﻲ ‪:‬‬
‫‪.2x Œ 4x Œ 8x Œ 32x Œ Normal‬‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺨﻄﻲ ﺑﻮﺣﺪﺓ ‪ 5‬ﺩﻗﺎﺋﻖ‬
‫ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪.W،X‬‬
‫• ﻳﺘﺨﻄﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺑﻮﺣﺪﺓ ‪ ٥‬ﺩﻗﺎﺋﻖ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻡ ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪. X‬‬
‫• ﻳﺘﺨﻄﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺑﻮﺣﺪﺓ ‪ ٥‬ﺩﻗﺎﺋﻖ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻒ ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪.W‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ‪ :‬ﻳﻘﻠﺐ ﻋﻤﻮﺩﻳﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ‪ :‬ﻳﺪﻭﺭ ﺑﺪﺭﺟﺔ ‪90‬‬
‫ﺑﺎﺗﺠﺎﻩ ﻣﻌﺎﻛﺲ ﻟﺤﺮﻛﺔ‬
‫ﻋﻘﺎﺭﺏ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﻋﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ‪ :‬ﻳﺪﻭﺭ ﺑﺪﺭﺟﺔ ‪90‬‬
‫ﺑﺎﺗﺠﺎﻩ ﺣﺮﻛﺔ ﻋﻘﺎﺭﺏ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﺎﻋﺔ‬
‫‪D‬‬
‫ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻷﺻﻠﻴﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ‪ :‬ﻳﻘﻠﺐ ﺃﻓﻘﻴﺎ‪.‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪D‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺩﺭﺟﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺤﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﻳﺪﻋﻤﻬﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ ﻫﻲ ‪) 3480 × 5120‬ﺃﻭ ‪ (MPixel 19.0‬ﻟﻤﻠﻔﺎﺕ ‪JPEG‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﺳﻴﺔ ﻭ‪) 1536 × 2048‬ﺃﻭ ‪ (MPixel 3.0‬ﻟﻤﻠﻔﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﻘﺪﻣﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﺗﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻣﻠﻒ ‪ JPEG‬ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﺩﺭﺟﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻮﺡ ﻟﺨﺮﺝ ‪ ،HDMI 720p/1080i/1080p‬ﻳﺘﺤﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻭﺿﻊ‬
‫‪ 576p/480p‬ﺁﻟﻴﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) AUDIO‬ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺗﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻌﺪﺩﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪ ،‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻮﻳﻞ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﺤﻮﻝ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭﻙ ﺑﻴﻦ‬
‫)‪ AUDIO(1/NK 2/N ...‬ﻭ ‪.‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ‬
‫ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻮﺟﺪ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻋﻮﻣﺔ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪.‬‬
‫ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ‬
‫‪D‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) SUBTITLE‬ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ‪ ،‬ﻳﺘﺤﻮﻝ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭﻙ ﺑﻴﻦ)‪SUBTITLE (1/N, 2/N ...‬‬
‫ﻭ ‪.OFF SUBTITLE‬‬
‫• ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺪ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻠﻪ ﺁﻟﻴﺎ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﻧﻈﺮ ﺭﻗﻢ ‪) 2‬ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺤﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻟﻴﺔ ﻟﻠﺘﻔﺎﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻌﻠﻘﺔ‬
‫ﺑﻜﻴﻔﻴﺔ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ ﻓﻲ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪.DivX‬‬
‫‪٣٠‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:12 PM‬‬
‫‪٣١‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 30-31‬‬
‫‪D‬‬
‫ﺍﺫﺍ ﻭﺟﺪ ﺃﻛﺒﺮ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺪ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‬
‫ﺍﺫﺍ ﻭﺟﺪ ﺃﻛﺒﺮ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺪ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﻳﻼﺋﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ ﺍﻻﻓﺘﺮﺍﺿﻲ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﻠﻢ ﻭﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﺨﺘﺎﺭ ﻟﻐﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﻠﻲ ‪:‬‬
‫‪BAGD‬‬
‫ﻋﺮﺽ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) INFO‬ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ(‪.‬‬
‫● ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫‪ .١‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ S,T‬ﺍﺧﺘﺮ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻏﻮﺏ ﻓﻴﻪ ) ( ﻣﻦ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‬
‫‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻳﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻋﺮﺽ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﻗﺮﺹ ﺍﻋﺘﻤﺎﺩﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺃﻳﻀﺎ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ‪ ،DTS، DOLBY DIGITAL‬ﺃﻭ ‪PRO‬‬
‫‪ LOGIC‬ﺍﻋﺘﻤﺎﺩﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﺨﺘﺎﺭ ﻣﻠﻒ ‪ DivX‬ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻏﻮﺏ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻜﻦ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﻴﻠﻢ ﺑﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻋﺎﺩﻳﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻳﻈﻬﺮ ﺭﻣﺰ‬
‫‪ : DivX )Digital internet video eXpress‬ﺍﻛﺴﺒﺮﺱ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻻﻧﺘﺮﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ(‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ !‬
‫ﺍﺫﺍ ﻇﻬﺮ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﺰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺯﺭﺍﺭ‪ ،‬ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺘﻮﻓﺮ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻣﺞ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐّﻞ ﺍﻵﻥ‪.‬‬
‫‪ DivX‬ﻫﻮ ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﻣﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺗﺘﻘﺪﻣﻪ ‪ Microsoft‬ﻭﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺳﺎﺱ ﺗﻘﻨﻴﺔ ﺿﻐﻂ ‪ MPEG٤‬ﻟﻠﺘﺰﻭﻳﺪ ﺑﺒﻴﺎﻧﺎﺕ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺍﻻﻧﺘﺮﻧﺐ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺤﻘﻴﻘﻲ‪.‬‬
‫ﻳﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ‪ MPEG٤‬ﻟﺘﺸﻔﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻭﻳﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ‪ MP٣‬ﻟﺘﺸﻔﻴﺮ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ ﻭﻟﺬﻟﻚ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﻟﻠﻤﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﻠﻢ ﺑﻨﻮﻋﻴﺔ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻭﺃﻭﺩﻳﻮ ‪.DVD‬‬
‫ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺍﻟﺘﺼﺎﻣﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻋﻮﻣﺔ‬
‫ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﻮﺝ ﻳﺰﻭّﺩ ﺑﺘﺼﺎﻣﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﻮﺳﻂ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻌﺪﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻟﻴﺔ ﻓﻘﻂ‪ .‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻟﻢ ﺗﺪﻋﻢ ﺗﺼﺎﻣﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻭﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﻳﻮﺍﺟﻪ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻜﻼﺕ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺘﺸﻮﻫﺔ ﺃﻭ ﻋﺪﻡ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﺗﺼﺎﻣﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻋﻮﻣﺔ‬
‫ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ‬
‫‪AVI‬‬
‫‪WMV‬‬
‫ﺍﻹﺻﺪﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻋﻮﻡ‬
‫‪DivX3.11~DivX5.1, XviD‬‬
‫‪V1/V2/V3/V7‬‬
‫‪DVD‬‬
‫‪AUDIO‬‬
‫ﻋﺮﺽ ‪DVD‬‬
‫ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ‬
‫ﻋﺮﺽ ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﺴﺘﻴﺮﻳﻮ‬
‫)ﺍﻟﻴﺴﺎﺭ‪/‬ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻴﻦ(‬
‫ﻋﺮﺽ ‪DVD-‬‬
‫‪AUDIO‬‬
‫ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻔﺼﻞ‬
‫ﻋﺮﺽ ﻟﻐﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ‬
‫ﻋﺮﺽ ‪DOLBY‬‬
‫‪) DIGITAL‬ﺩﻭﻟﺒﻲ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ(‬
‫ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻣﺞ‬
‫ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺎﺭ‬
‫)ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻒ(‬
‫ﻋﺮﺽ ‪AUDIO‬‬
‫‪LANGUAGE‬‬
‫ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﺰﺍﻭﻳﺔ‬
‫ﻋﺮﺽ ﻭﻗﺖ‬
‫ﺍﻻﻧﻘﻀﺎء‬
‫ﻋﺮﺽ ‪SUBTITLE‬‬
‫ﺗﺼﺎﻣﻴﻢ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻋﻮﻣﺔ‬
‫ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ‬
‫‪MP3‬‬
‫‪WMA‬‬
‫‪AC3‬‬
‫‪DTS‬‬
‫ﺳﺮﻋﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﺘﺎﺕ‬
‫‪384kbps~80‬‬
‫‪128kbps~56‬‬
‫‪384kbps~128‬‬
‫‪1.5Mbps‬‬
‫‪44.1/48khz‬‬
‫‪44.1khz‬‬
‫ﺗﺮﺩﺩ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﻴﻴﻦ‬
‫‪44.1khz‬‬
‫• ﺗﺪﻋﻢ ﻣﻠﻔﺎﺕ ‪ DivX‬ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﺤﺘﻮﻱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻠﻔﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻭﺗﻨﺘﺞ ﺑﺘﺼﻤﻴﻢ ‪ DTS‬ﺣﺘﻰ ‪.Mbps 6‬‬
‫• ﻧﺴﺒﺔ ﺍﻻﻣﺘﺪﺍﺩ ‪ :‬ﺑﺎﻟﺮﻏﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺣﻠﻮﻝ ‪ DivX‬ﺍﻟﻤﺼﻨﻌﻲ ‪ 480*640‬ﻓﻴﻜﺴﻞ)‪ ،(4:3‬ﻳﺪﻋﻢ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﻮﺝ ﺣﺘﻰ ‪ 480*720‬ﻓﻴﻤﺴﻞ )‪.(16:9‬‬
‫ﻟﻦ ﻳﺪﻋﻢ ﺣﻠﻮﻝ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺃﻛﺒﺮ ﻣﻦ ‪.800‬‬
‫• ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﺸﻐّﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺗﺮﺩﺩ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﻟﻪ ﺃﻛﺒﺮ ﻣﻦ ‪ khz 48‬ﺃﻭ ‪ ،kbps 320‬ﻗﺪ ﺗﻮﺍﺟﻪ ﺍﻫﺘﺰﺍﺯ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ‬
‫• ﻳﺠﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻚ ﺃﻥ ّ‬
‫ﺗﺠﺮﺏ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺮﺍﺝ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻭﺗﺤﺮﻳﺮﻫﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻤﻴﺰﺓ ﺑﺸﻜﻞ ﻣﻨﺎﺳﺐ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻻﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﺍﺣﻔﻆ ﻣﻠﻒ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ )*‪ (smi.‬ﻓﻲ ﻧﻔﺲ ﺍﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻒ ﻟﻤﻠﻒ) ‪ DivX (*.avi‬ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﻧﻔﺲ ﺍﻟﻤﺠﻠّﺪ‪.‬‬
‫‪Samsung _007CD1.avi‬‬
‫ﻣﺜﺎﻝ‪ .‬ﺃﺻﻞ‬
‫‪Samsung _007CD1.smi‬‬
‫• ﺣﺘﻰ ‪ 60‬ﺣﺮﻑ ﺃﺑﺠﺪﻱ ﺭﻗﻤﻴﺄﻭ ‪ 30‬ﺣﺮﻑ ﺷﺮﻕ ﺍﺳﻴﺎﻭﻱ )‪ 2‬ﺑﻴﺖ ﺣﺮﻭﻑ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻛﻮﺭﻱ ﻭﺻﻴﻨﻲ( ﻻﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻒ‪.‬‬
‫‪BA‬‬
‫ﻓﺤﺺ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﺒﻘﻲ‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) REMAIN‬ﺍﻟﻤﺘﺒﻘﻲ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﻟﻔﺤﺺ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻲ ﻭﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﺒﻘﻲ ﻟﻠﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻔﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐّﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) REMAIN‬ﺍﻟﻤﺘﺒﻘﻰ(‬
‫‪DVD-VIDEO‬‬
‫‪TITLE ELAPSED ➞ TITLE REMAIN ➞ CHAPTER ELAPSED ➞ CHAPTER REMAIN‬‬
‫‪DVD-AUDIO‬‬
‫‪GROUP ELAPSED ➞ GROUP REMAIN ➞ TRACK ELAPSED ➞ TRACK REMAIN‬‬
‫‪B‬‬
‫‪TRACK REMAIN ➞ TRACK ELAPSED A‬‬
‫‪TRACK ELAPSED ➞ TRACK REMAIN ➞ TOTAL ELAPSED ➞ TOTAL REMAIN‬‬
‫‪٣٢‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:13 PM‬‬
‫‪٣٣‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 32-33‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﻳﻊ‬
‫ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫‪BAD‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‪. ,‬‬
‫• ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺗﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﺳﺮﻋﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﻠﻲ ‪:‬‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻓﺼﻞ‪ ،‬ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻣﺴﺎﺭ )ﺃﻏﻨﻴﺔ(‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ )ﻣﻠﻒ ‪(MP3‬‬
‫ﺑﺎﺗﺴﻤﺮﺍﺭ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) REPEAT‬ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻳﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﻠﻲ ‪:‬‬
‫‪2X ➞  4X ➞  8X ➞  32X ➞ X PLAY ‬‬
‫‪DVD-AUDIO‬‬
‫‪REPEAT : CHAPTER ➞ REPEAT : TITLE ➞ REPEAT : OFF‬‬
‫‪REPEAT : TRACK ➞ REPEAT : GROUP ➞ REPEAT : OFF‬‬
‫‪REPEAT : TRACK ➞ REPEAT : DISC ➞ REPEAT : OFF‬‬
‫‪BGD‬‬
‫‪REPEAT : RANDOM ➞ REPEAT : TRACK ➞ REPEAT : DIR‬‬
‫➞ ‪REPEAT : DISC ➞ REPEAT : OFF‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﻳﻊ ﻟﻠﻘﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻣﺞ ﺃﻭ ﻗﺮﺹ ﻣﺪﻣﺞ – ‪ ،MP3‬ﻳﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺑﺴﺮﻋﺔ × ‪ 2‬ﻓﻘﻂ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﺑﺴﺮﻋﺔ ×‪،8× ،4‬‬
‫ﻭ×‪.32‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﻲء‬
‫‪D‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) SLOW‬ﺍﻟﺒﻄﻲء(‪.‬‬
‫• ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺗﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﺳﺮﻋﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﻠﻲ ‪:‬‬
‫‪➞ 1/4 ➞ 1/2 ➞ 1/8 ➞ 1/4 ➞ 1/2‬‬
‫‪) CHAPTER‬ﺍﻟﻔﺼﻞ( ‪ :‬ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻔﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺘﺎﺭ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﻤﺮﺍﺭ‪.‬‬
‫‪) TITLE‬ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ( ‪ :‬ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺘﺎﺭ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﻤﺮﺍﺭ‪.‬‬
‫‪) GROUP‬ﺍﻟﺠﻤﺎﻋﺔ( ‪ :‬ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺠﻤﺎﻋﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺘﺎﺭﺓ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﻤﺮﺍﺭ‬
‫‪) RANDOM‬ﺍﻟﻌﺸﻮﺍﺋﻲ( ‪ :‬ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﺮﺑﻴﺐ ﺍﻟﻌﺸﻮﺍﺋﻲ‪) .‬ﻗﺪ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺗﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻠﻪ ﺳﺎﺑﻘﺎ ﻣﺮﺓ ﺛﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪(.‬‬
‫‪) TRACK‬ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺎﺭ( ‪ :‬ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺘﺎﺭ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﻤﺮﺍﺭ‪.‬‬
‫‪) DIR‬ﺍﻟﺪﻟﻴﻞ( ‪ :‬ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺪﻟﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺘﺎﺭ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﻤﺮﺍﺭ‪.‬‬
‫‪) DISC‬ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ( ‪ :‬ﻳﺸﻐّﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﻛﻠﻪ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﻤﺮﺍﺭ‪.‬‬
‫‪) OFF‬ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ( ‪ :‬ﻳﺘﻢ ﺇﻟﻐﺎء ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫‪X PLAY ➞ 1/8‬‬
‫‪D‬‬
‫● ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫‪2X ➞  4X ➞  8X ➞  32X ➞ X PLAY ‬‬
‫‪DVD-VIDEO‬‬
‫‪CD‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫‪BAGD‬‬
‫ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻓﻲ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‬
‫‪X PLAY ➞ 1/8 ➞ 1/4 ➞ 1/2‬‬
‫‪B‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) INFO‬ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ( ﻣﺮﺗﻴﻦ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ X‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻋﺮﺽ ‪REPEAT PLAYBACK‬‬
‫)ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ( ) (‪.‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ T‬ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪) Repeat Playback‬ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ( ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺏ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻷﻟﺒﻮﻡ ﻭﺍﻟﻤﺴﺎﺭ ﺍﻵﺧﺮ‪ ،‬ﻗﻢ ﺑﺘﻜﺮﺍﺭ ﺧﻄﻮﺗﻴﻦ ‪ ٢‬ﻭ‪ ٣‬ﺃﻋﻼﻩ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻻ ﻳﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﻲء‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻻ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﻲء ﺍﻟﻌﻜﺴﻲ ﻓﻲ ‪.DivX‬‬
‫ﺗﺨﻄﻲ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺎﻇﺮ‪/‬ﺍﻷﻏﺎﻧﻲ‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪.#,$‬‬
‫• ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺰﺭﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻔﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻖ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻟﻲ‪،‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺎﺭ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺪﻟﻴﻞ )ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻒ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺗﺨﻄﻲ ﺍﻟﻔﺼﻮﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺎﻗﺐ‪.‬‬
‫‪٣٤‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:15 PM‬‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫‪A‬‬
‫‪OFF ➞ A- ➞ CHAP ➞ TITLE ➞ OFF‬‬
‫‪B‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪OFF ➞ A- ➞ TRACK ➞ DISC ➞ OFF‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ DivX، MP3‬ﻭ‪ ،JPEG‬ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ‪.‬‬
‫‪٣٥‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 34-35‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﺰﺍﻭﻳﺔ‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﻧﻔﺲ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﻈﺮ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺰﻭﺍﻳﺎ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺘﻠﻔﺔ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) INFO‬ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ(‪.‬‬
‫ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻳﻪ – ﺑﻲ‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ X‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻋﺮﺽ ‪) ANGLE‬ﺍﻟﺰﺍﻭﻳﺔ( )‬
‫(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪S,T‬ﺃﻭ ﺍﻷﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳﺔ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﺍﻭﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺑﺔ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ‪ ،‬ﺗﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﺰﺍﻭﻳﺔ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﻠﻲ ‪:‬‬
‫‪➞ 2/3‬‬
‫‪➞ 3/3‬‬
‫‪➞ 1/3‬‬
‫‪1/3‬‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﻄﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺼﺼﺔ ﻓﻲ ‪ DVD‬ﺑﺎﺳﺘﻤﺮﺍﺭ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) INFO‬ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ( ﻣﺮﺗﻴﻦ‪.‬‬
‫● ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ X‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻋﺮﺽ ‪REPEAT PLAYBACK‬‬
‫)ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ( ) (‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ S,T‬ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ‪ -A‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫)ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺨﺰﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﻗﻊ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺘﺎﺭ‬
‫ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺬﺍﻛﺮﺓ‪.‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﻓﻲ ﻧﻬﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﻄﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺑﺔ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﻄﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺼﺼﺔ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﻤﺮﺍﺭ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﺰﺍﻭﻳﺔ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﻢ ﺗﺴﺠﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺰﻭﺍﻳﺎ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻌﺪﺩﺓ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﻘﻂ‪.‬‬
‫‪A-B‬‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﺰﻭﻡ )ﺗﻜﺒﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ(‬
‫ﻟﻠﺮﺟﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺩﻱ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ S,T‬ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ )‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ZOOM‬ﺍﻟﺰﻭﻡ(‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻟﻦ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪ A-B REPEAT‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ DivX، MP3‬ﺃﻭ ‪. .JPEG‬‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﺨﻄﻮﺓ‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) STEP‬ﺍﻟﺨﻄﻮﺓ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﺗﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻡ ﺑﺎﻃﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪٣٦‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:15 PM‬‬
‫(‪) OFF‬ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ(‪.‬‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺗﻜﺒﻴﺮ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﺔ ﺧﺎﺻﺔ ﻟﻠﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﺮﻭﺿﺔ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ S,T,W,X‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻋﺮﺽ ‪ANGLE‬‬
‫(‪.‬‬
‫)ﺍﻟﺰﺍﻭﻳﺔ( )‬
‫‪D‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ‪ ،‬ﻳﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺰﻭﻡ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﻠﻲ ‪:‬‬
‫‪ZOOM X 1.5 € ZOOM X 2 € ZOOM X 3 € ZOOM OFF‬‬
‫‪SELECT ZOOM POSITION‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻻ ﻳﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﺨﻄﻮﺓ‪.‬‬
‫‪٣٧‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 36-37‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺠﻤﺎﻋﺔ ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻴﺔ‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) INFO‬ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ( ﻣﺮﺗﻴﻦ‪.‬‬
‫‪DVD-AUDIO‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ X‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻋﺮﺽ ‪) SUBTITLE‬ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ(‬
‫) (‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ T‬ﺃﻭ ﺍﻷﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳﺔ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺏ‪.‬‬
‫ﺑﻌﺾ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ DVD-Audio‬ﺗﻤﻠﻚ ﺟﻤﺎﻋﺔ »ﺇﺿﺎﻓﻴﺔ« ﺧﺎﺻﺔ ﺗﻄﻠﺐ ‪ – 4‬ﺃﺭﻗﺎﻡ ﻣﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ‬
‫ﻋﺪﺩﻳﺔ ﻟﻠﺘﻮﺍﺻﻞ‪ .‬ﺍﻧﻈﺮ ﺻﻨﺪﻭﻕ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﻟﻠﺘﻔﺎﺻﻴﻞ ﻭﺭﻗﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺘﺎﺡ‪.‬‬
‫‪EN 01/03 € SP 02/03 € FR 03/03 € OFF/03 € EN 01/03‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﺃﺧﺮﺟﺖ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﺿﻐﻄﺖ ﺯﺭ ﻗﻄﻊ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﻓﺼﻠﺖ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐّﻞ‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﺤﺘﺎﺝ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺇﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﺭﻗﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺘﺎﺡ ﻣﺮﺓ‬
‫ﺛﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫● ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻘﻮﻡ ﺑﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻗﺮﺹ ‪ DVD-Audio‬ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺗﻮﺟﺪ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺠﻤﺎﻋﺔ ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ‬
‫ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺇﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﺭﻗﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺘﺎﺡ ﺗﻠﻘﺎﺋﻴﺎ‪.‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻟﻐﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ‬
‫‪ ‬ﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ‪ ،‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺃﻳﻀﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺯﺭ ‪) SUBTITLE‬ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ( ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺴﺐ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻟﻐﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ‪.‬‬
‫‪BAG‬‬
‫ﺍﻻﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﻈﺮ‪/‬ﺍﻷﻏﻨﻴﺔ ﻣﺒﺎﺷﺮﺓ‬
‫‪B‬‬
‫ﺻﻔﺤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﻼﺣﺔ‬
‫ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ,,.‬ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺍﻟﻔﺔ‪/‬ﺍﻟﻘﻨﺎﺓ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺑﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺮﺹ ‪ DVD-Audio‬ﺍﻟﻤﺤﺘﻮﻱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺜﺎﺑﺘﺔ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻓﻲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﺗﺴﺘﻄﻴﻊ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) INFO‬ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ( ﻣﺮﺗﻴﻦ‪.‬‬
‫‪DVD-AUDIO‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ S,T‬ﺃﻭ ﺍﻷﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳﺔ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ‪/‬ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺎﺭ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺏ ) ( ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ W,X‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻔﺼﻞ )‬
‫(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ S,T‬ﺃﻭ ﺍﻷﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳﺔ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻔﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺏ ﻭﺑﻌﺪ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٥‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ W,X‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ )‬
‫(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٦‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳﺔ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺏ ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‬
‫‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫‪AG‬‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻟﻐﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) INFO‬ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ( ﻣﺮﺗﻴﻦ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ S,T‬ﺃﻭ ﺍﻷﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳﺔ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻟﻐﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺑﺔ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺣﺴﺐ ﺭﻗﻢ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺠﻠﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺮﺹ ‪ ،DVD‬ﻳﺘﻢ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻟﻐﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺘﻠﻔﺔ‬
‫)ﺍﻧﺠﻴﻠﻴﺰﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﺳﺒﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﻧﺴﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﺦ( ﻛﻞ ﻣﺮﺓ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳﺔ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺘﺎﺭ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻗﺮﺹ ‪ MP3‬ﺃﻭ ‪ ،JPEG‬ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ S,T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺪﻟﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻻﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺪﻟﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ‪) STOP‬ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ( )¦( ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪. S,T‬‬
‫‪EN 1/3 € SP 2/3 € FR 3/3 € EN 1/3‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ‪ ،‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺃﻳﻀﺎ ﺍﻟﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) AUDIO‬ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﻟﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ #,$‬ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﻔﺼﻞ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺏ‬
‫ﻣﺒﺎﺷﺮﺓ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺴﺐ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪ ،‬ﻻ ﺗﺴﺘﻄﻴﻊ ﺍﻻﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺘﺎﺭ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺍﻋﺘﻤﺎﺩﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻟﻐﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ‪.‬‬
‫‪٣٨‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:17 PM‬‬
‫‪٣٩‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 38-39‬‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺴﺘﻤﺘﻊ ﺑﻤﻠﻔﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻮﺳﻂ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﺍﻷﻓﻼﻡ ﻭﺍﻟﻤﻮﺳﻴﻘﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻔﻮﻇﺔ ﻓﻲ ﻣﺸﻐّﻞ ‪ ،MP3‬ﻭﻣﺾ ﺫﺍﻛﺮﺓ ‪ USB‬ﻭﺍﻟﻜﺎﻣﻴﺮﺍ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ ﻓﻲ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻣﻊ ﺻﻮﺕ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ ﺑﻘﻨﺎﺓ ‪ 5.1‬ﻋﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺰﻥ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻓﺘﺤﺔ ‪ USB‬ﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺻﻞ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ‪ USB‬ﺍﻟﻰ ﻓﺘﺤﺔ ‪ USB‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻴﺔ ﻟﻠﻮﺣﺪﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) MENU‬ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ( ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ S,T‬ﺃﻭ ﺍﻷﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳﺔ ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ »‪«Disc Menu‬‬
‫)ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ( ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﺨﺘﺎﺭ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﻗﺮﺹ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺪﻋﻤﺔ ﺑﻮﺍﺳﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪ ،‬ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺭﺳﺎﻟﺔ »‪This‬‬
‫‪) «menu is not supported‬ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺪﻋﻮﻣﺔ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ‪.‬‬
‫● ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) FUNCTION‬ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺸﻐّﻞ ‪ DVD‬ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ‬
‫‪) PORT‬ﺍﻟﻔﺘﺤﺔ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪.USB‬‬
‫• ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ‪ USB‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻳﺘﻼﺷﻰ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ‪ USB MENU‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻭﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻔﻮﻅ‪.‬‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻗﻮﺍﺋﻢ ﻟﻐﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ‪ ،‬ﻟﻐﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ‪) profile ،‬ﺑﺮﻭﻓﻴﻞ(‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﻴﺮﻫﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻣﺤﺘﻮﻳﺎﺕ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ‪ DVD‬ﺗﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺴﺐ ﻗﺮﺹ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) STOP‬ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ( )¦(‪.‬‬
‫ﺇﺯﺍﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﻔﺘﺤﺔ ﺑﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺁﻣﻨﺔ‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ S,T,W,X‬ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺑﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻟﻤﻨﻊ ﻓﻘﺪﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺎﻧﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻔﻮﻇﺔ ﻓﻲ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ‪ ،USB‬ﻗﻢ ﺑﻄﺮﻳﻘﺔ ﺍﻹﺯﺍﻟﺔ ﺍﻵﻣﻨﺔ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻓﺼﻞ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ‪.USB‬‬
‫• ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) STOP‬ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ( )¦( ﻣﺮﺗﻴﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺎﻗﺐ‪.‬‬
‫ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ‪.REMOVE USB‬‬
‫• ﻗﻢ ﺑﺈﺯﺍﻟﺔ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ‪.USB‬‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) EXIT‬ﺍﻟﺨﺮﻭﺝ( ﻣﻦ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ‪.‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻣﻠﻔﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻮﺳﻂ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻣﻤﻴﺰﺓ ‪USB HOST‬‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻗﺪ ﻳﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻋﺮﺽ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺴﺐ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻟﻼﺳﺘﻤﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻣﻠﻔﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺳﻴﻘﻰ ﺑﺼﻮﺕ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻢﻧﺰﻟﻲ ﺑﻘﻨﺎﺓ ‪ ،5.1‬ﻳﺠﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻀﺒﻂ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪Dolby Pro Logic‬‬
‫‪ II‬ﺍﻟﻰ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪) .Matrix‬ﺍﻧﻈﺮ ﺻﻔﺤﺔ ‪(٥٣‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺨﻄﻲ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻡ‪/‬ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻒ‬
‫ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‪. # , $‬‬
‫• ﻳﺘﻢ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻟﻲ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ ، $‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺃﻛﺒﺮ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻒ ﻓﻲ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﺘﻢ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻖ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ ،#‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺃﻛﺒﺮ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻒ ﻓﻲ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ‬
‫ﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ DVD‬ﺍﻟﻤﺤﺘﻮﻳﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﻨﺎﻭﻳﻦ ﻣﺘﻌﺪﺩﺓ‪ ،‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻛﻞ ﻓﻴﻠﻢ‪ .‬ﺍﻋﺘﻤﺎﺩﺍ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺃﺑﺪﺍ ﺃﻭ ﻗﺪ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﺑﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻔﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) MENU‬ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ( ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ S,T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪) Title Menu‬ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) EXIT‬ﺍﻟﺨﺮﻭﺝ( ﻣﻦ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ‪.‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪٤٠‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:17 PM‬‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻗﺪ ﻳﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻋﺮﺽ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺴﺐ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪.‬‬
‫‪٤١‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 40-41‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺭﺍﺣﺘﻚ‪ ،‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺿﺒﻂ ﻣﻤﻴﺰﺍﺕ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ ‪ DVD‬ﻷﻓﻀﻞ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻓﻲ ﺑﻴﺌﺔ ﻣﻨﺰﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﻳﻊ‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺔ‬
‫ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻞ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‪.,‬‬
‫• ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻭﺗﻤﺴﻚ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺗﺘﺤﻮﻝ ﺳﺮﻋﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﻠﻲ ‪:‬‬
‫ﺗﻀﺒﻂ ﻟﻐﺔ ‪) OSD‬ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰﻱ ﺍﻓﺘﺮﺍﺿﻴﺎ‪.‬‬
‫‪.2x € 4x € 8x € 32x € Normal‬‬
‫● ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ‬
‫‪ .١‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) MENU‬ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪) Setup‬ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ( ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺧﺘﺮ ‪) Language‬ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺔ( ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫ﺍﻷﺟﻬﺰﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻄﺎﺑﻘﺔ‬
‫‪.١‬‬
‫‪.٢‬‬
‫‪.٣‬‬
‫‪.٤‬‬
‫‪.٥‬‬
‫‪.٦‬‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ S,T‬ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ‪) OSD Language‬ﻟﻐﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ(‬
‫ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫ﺃﺟﻬﺰﺓ ‪ USB‬ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﺪﻋﻢ ‪.USB Mass Storage V1.0‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺤﺮﻙ ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ‪.‬‬
‫ّ‬
‫)ﺃﺟﻬﺰﺓ ‪ USB‬ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻛﻘﺮﺹ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﻟﻠﻨﻘﻞ ﻓﻲ ‪ Windows (2000‬ﺃﻭ ﺃﺣﺪﺙ( ﺩﻭﻥ ﺗﺮﻛﻴﺐ‬
‫ﻣﺸﻐّﻞ ‪ MP3 : HDD‬ﻭﻣﺸﻐّﻞ ‪ MP3‬ﺑﻨﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﻮﻣﺾ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻣﻴﺮﺍ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ ‪ :‬ﻛﺎﻣﻴﺮﺍ ﺗﺪﻋﻢ ‪USB Mass Storage v1.0‬‬
‫• ﻛﺎﻣﻴﺮﺍ ﻳﺸﻐّﻞ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﻟﻠﻨﻘﻞ ﻓﻲ ‪ Windows (2000‬ﺃﻭ ﺃﺣﺪﺙ( ﺩﻭﻥ ﺗﺮﻛﻴﺐ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﺮﻙ ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ‪.‬‬
‫‪ USB HDD‬ﻭ‪ : USB Flash Drive‬ﺃﺟﻬﺰﺓ ﺗﺪﻋﻢ ‪ USB2.0‬ﺃﻭ ‪.USB1.1‬‬
‫ﺗﺠﺮﺏ ﺍﻻﺧﺘﻼﻑ ﻓﻲ ﻧﻮﻋﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻮﺻﻞ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ‪.USB1.1‬‬
‫• ﻗﺪ ّ‬
‫• ﻟـ ‪ ،USB HDD‬ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺳﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪ USB HDD‬ﻟﻠﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺎﺳﺐ‪.‬‬
‫ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﻗﺮﺍءﺓ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ‪ : USB‬ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﻗﺮﺍءﺓ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ‪ USB‬ﺫﺍﺕ ﻓﺘﺤﺔ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﻭ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﻗﺮﺍءﺓ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ‪ USB‬ﺫﺍﺕ ﻓﺘﺤﺎﺕ ﻣﺘﻌﺪﺩﺓ‬
‫• ﺍﻋﺘﻤﺎﺩﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﻳﺪﻋﻢ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﻗﺮﺍءﺓ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ‪.USB‬‬
‫• ﺍﺫﺍ ﻗﻤﺖ ﺑﺘﺮﻛﻴﺐ ﺃﺟﻬﺰﺓ ﺍﻟﺬﺍﻛﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻌﺪﺩﺓ ﻓﻲ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﻗﺮﺍءﺓ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻌﺪﺩﺓ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﺗﻮﺍﺟﻪ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻜﻼﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺫﺍ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻣﺖ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ﺗﻤﺪﻳﺪ ‪ ،USB‬ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﻳﻌﺘﺮﻑ ﺑﺠﻬﺎﺯ ‪.USB‬‬
‫‪ .٥‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ S,T‬ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺑﺔ ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻤﻞ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ‪) OSD‬ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ(‬
‫ﺍﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰﻳﺎ ﺍﺫﺍ ﺗﻢ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺔ ﺍﻧﺠﻴﻠﻴﺰﻳﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) RETURN‬ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩﺓ( ﻟﻠﺮﺟﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻖ ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) EXIT‬ﺍﻟﺨﺮﻭﺝ( ﻟﻠﺨﺮﻭﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ‪.‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺼﻤﻴﻢ‬
‫ﺍﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻒ‬
‫ﺗﻤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻒ‬
‫ﺳﺮﻋﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﺘﺎﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻹﺻﺪﺍﺭ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﻴﻜﺴﻞ‬
‫ﺗﺮﺩﺩ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﻴﻴﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﺑﺘﺔ‬
‫‪JPG‬‬
‫‪JPG‬‬
‫‪.JPEG‬‬
‫–‬
‫–‬
‫‪640x480‬‬
‫–‬
‫‪MP3‬‬
‫‪MP3.‬‬
‫‪384kbps~80‬‬
‫–‬
‫–‬
‫‪44.1kHz‬‬
‫‪WMA‬‬
‫‪WMA.‬‬
‫‪128kbps~56‬‬
‫‪V8‬‬
‫–‬
‫‪44.1kHz‬‬
‫‪WMV‬‬
‫‪WMV.‬‬
‫‪4Mbps‬‬
‫‪V1,V2,V3,V7‬‬
‫‪720x480‬‬
‫‪44.1KHz~48KHz‬‬
‫‪DivX‬‬
‫‪AVI,.ASF.‬‬
‫‪4Mbps‬‬
‫‪~DivX3.11‬‬
‫‪DivX5.1, XviD‬‬
‫‪720x480‬‬
‫‪44.1KHz~48KHz‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﻴﻠﻢ‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫•‬
‫•‬
‫•‬
‫•‬
‫‪٤٢‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:18 PM‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫• ‪ : OTHERS‬ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻟﻐﺔ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ‪ ،‬ﺍﺧﺘﺮ ‪) OTHERS‬ﺍﻵﺧﺮ( ﻭﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﺭﻣﺰ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺔ ﻟﺪﻭﻟﺘﻚ‪.‬‬
‫)ﺍﻧﻈﺮ ﺻﻔﺤﺔ ‪(٥٩‬‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻟﻐﺎﺕ ‪) AUDIO‬ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ(‪) SUBTITLE ،‬ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ(‪ ،‬ﻭ‬
‫‪) DISC MENU‬ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ(‪.‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫•‬
‫•‬
‫•‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫• ‪ : OSD LANGUAGE‬ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻟﻐﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ‬
‫• ‪ : AUDIO‬ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻟﻐﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ )ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺠﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ(‬
‫• ‪ : SUBTITLE‬ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻟﻐﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ )ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺠﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ(‬
‫• ‪ : DISC MENU‬ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻟﻐﺔ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ )ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺠﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ(‬
‫‪ a‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻟﻢ ﺗﺴﺠﻞ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﺨﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪ ،‬ﻟﻦ ﺗﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﻟﻐﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺣﺘﻰ ﻟﻮ ﺿﺒﻄﺘﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺑﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺼﺎﻣﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻋﻮﻣﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺳﻴﻘﻰ‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪SELECT‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫ﻻ ﻳﺪﻋﻢ) ‪.CBI (Control/Bulk/Interrupt‬‬
‫ﻻ ﺗﺪﻋﻢ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻣﻴﺮﺍ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﺑﺮﻭﺗﻮﻛﻮﻝ ‪ PTP‬ﺃﻭ ﺗﻄﻠﺐ ﺗﺮﻛﻴﺐ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻧﺎﻣﺞ ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻜﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ ﺍﻟﺸﺨﺼﻲ‪.‬‬
‫ﻻ ﻳﺪﻋﻢ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﻣﻠﻒ ‪) .NTFS‬ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ ﻳﺪﻋﻢ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﻣﻠﻒ ‪ FAT‬ﻓﻘﻂ ﻭﻟﻦ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﻠﻢ ﺑﺤﺠﻢ ﺃﻛﺒﺮ ‪ 1GB‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ‬
‫‪(.USB‬‬
‫ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﺗﻴﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻣﺸﻐّﻼﺕ ‪ MP3‬ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﻮﺝ ﺍﻋﺘﻤﺎﺩﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺠﻢ ﺍﻟﻘﻄﺎﻉ ﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻒ‪.‬‬
‫ﻻ ﺗﺪﻋﻢ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪ USB HOST‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﺗﻢ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻣﻨﺘﻮﺝ ﻳﻨﻘﻞ ﻣﻠﻔﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻮﺳﻂ ﺑﻮﺍﺳﻄﺔ ﺑﺮﻧﺎﻣﺞ ﺍﻟﺼﺎﻧﻊ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺹ‪.‬‬
‫ﻻ ﺗﺸﻐّﻞ ﻣﻊ ‪ Janus‬ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﻋﻤﻠﻪ ﻣﻊ ﺃﺟﻬﺰﺓ )‪ : Media Transfer Protocol MTP‬ﺑﺮﻭﺗﻮﻛﻮﻝ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﻟﻮﺳﻂ(‪.‬‬
‫ﻻ ﺗﺪﻋﻢ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪ USB HOST‬ﻟﻬﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﻮﺝ ﻛﻞ ﺃﺟﻬﺰﺓ ‪ .USB‬ﻟﻠﺤﺼﻮﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﻷﺟﻬﺰﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻋﻮﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﻧﻈﺮ ﺻﻔﺤﺔ ‪.٥٨‬‬
‫‪٤٣‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 42-43‬‬
‫ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ‬
‫ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻟﻤﻨﻊ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ DVD‬ﻟﻠﻤﺮﺍﻫﻘﻴﻦ ﻭﺍﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻴﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﻻ ﺗﺮﻳﺪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺸﺎﻫﺪﻫﺎ ﺍﻷﻃﻔﺎﻝ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) MENU‬ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ(‪.‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪) Setup‬ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ( ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫ﺍﻋﻤﺎﺩﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻧﻚ )ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﻳﻀﺔ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻘﻠﻴﺪﻳﺔ ‪ ،(4:3‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻧﺴﺒﺔ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪) PARENTAL‬ﺍﻷﺑﻮﻱ( ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‬
‫‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) MENU‬ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪) TV DISPLAY‬ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ( ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫‪ .٥‬ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻭﺭ ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﺗﻢ ﺿﺒﻂ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻭﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ »‪ «7890‬ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻤﺼﻨﻊ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻋﻨﺪ ﺇﻛﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﺠﺪ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻘﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) RETURN‬ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩﺓ( ﻟﻠﺮﺟﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻖ ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) EXIT‬ﺍﻟﺨﺮﻭﺝ( ﻟﻠﺨﺮﻭﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ‪.‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫‪SELECT‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫● ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ S,T‬ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺘﻘﺪﻳﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺏ ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‬
‫‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﺫﺍ ﺍﺧﺘﺮﺕ ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻯ ‪ ،6‬ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ DVD‬ﻓﻲ ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻯ ‪ ٧‬ﺃﻭ ﺃﻛﺒﺮ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺃﻋﻠﻰ‪ ،‬ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﻗﺘﺮﺏ ﻣﺤﺘﻮﻱ ‪ DVD‬ﺃﻗﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻓﻼﻡ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻒ ﺃﻭ ﻣﺎﺩﺓ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺮﺍﻫﻘﻴﻦ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪) Setup‬ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ( ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ S,T‬ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺑﺔ ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﻋﻨﺪ ﺇﻛﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﺸﺎﻫﺪ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻘﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﺍﻷﺑﻮﻱ )ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺘﻘﺪﻳﺮ(‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) RETURN‬ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩﺓ( ﻟﻠﺮﺟﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻖ ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) EXIT‬ﺍﻟﺨﺮﻭﺝ( ﻟﻠﺨﺮﻭﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ‪.‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪SELECT‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ )ﻧﺴﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ(‬
‫ﻧﺴﺒﺔ ﺣﺠﻢ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻷﻓﻘﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﻮﺩﻳﺔ ﻟﻠﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺘﻘﻠﻴﺪﻱ ﻫﻲ ‪ ،4:3‬ﺃﻣﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺴﺒﺔ ﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻋﺮﻳﻀﺔ ﻭﺷﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻮﺡ ﻓﻬﻲ ‪ .16:9‬ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺒﺔ‬
‫ﺗﺴﻤﻰ ﺑﻨﺴﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﺎﻧﺐ‪ .‬ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ DVD‬ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺠﻠﺔ ﺑﺤﺠﻢ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺘﻠﻒ‪ ،‬ﻳﺠﺐ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻀﺒﻂ ﻧﺴﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﺎﻧﺐ ﻟﺘﺜﺒﻴﺘﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺻﺔ ﺑﻚ‪.‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺍﺣﺘﻮﻯ ﻗﺮﺹ ‪ DVD‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﺣﻮﻝ ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺘﻘﺪﻳﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻭﺭ‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺿﺒﻂ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻭﺭ ﻟﻠﻀﺒﻂ ﺍﻷﺑﻮﻱ )ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺘﻘﺪﻳﺮ(‪.‬‬
‫ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺴﺒﺔ ﻟﻠﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﺳﻲ‪ ،‬ﺍﺧﺘﺮ »‪ «4:3LB‬ﺃﻭ »‪ «4:3PS‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺴﺐ ﺍﻟﺘﻔﻀﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﺨﺼﻲ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺧﺘﺮ ‪ WIDE/HDTV‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻣﻠﻜﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺫﻭ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﻋﺮﻳﻀﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪( 4:3 Pan&Scan) 4:3PS‬‬
‫ﺍﺧﺘﺮﻫﺎ ﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ‪ 16:9‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪ Pan&Scan‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺘﻘﻠﻴﺪﻱ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺠﺰء ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ ﻟﻠﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﻓﻘﻂ )ﻣﻊ ﺇﺯﺍﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﺎﻧﺒﻴﻦ ﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ‪.(16:9‬‬
‫‪ ) 4:3LB‬ﺻﻨﺪﻭﻕ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻳﺪ ‪(4:3‬‬
‫ﺍﺧﺘﺮﻫﺎ ﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ‪ 16:9‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺻﻨﺪﻭﻕ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻳﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺘﻘﻠﻴﺪﻱ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺃﻋﻤﺪﺓ ﺳﻮﺩﺍء ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺠﺰء ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻱ ﻭﺍﻟﺠﺰء ﺍﻷﺳﻔﻞ ﻟﻠﺸﺎﺷﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) MENU‬ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪) Setup‬ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ( ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪) PASSWORD‬ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻭﺭ( ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٥‬ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻭﺭ ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻭﺭ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﻳﻤﺔ ﻭﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻭﺭ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﻳﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻭﺭ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﻳﺪﺓ ﻣﺮﺓ ﺛﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻟﻠﺘﺄﻛﻴﺪ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺗﻢ ﺇﻛﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ‪.‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪WIDE/HDTV‬‬
‫ﺍﺧﺘﺮﻫﺎ ﻟﻤﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ‪ 16:9‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻣﻠﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﻳﻀﺔ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻤﺘﺎﻉ ﺑﻨﺴﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﻳﻀﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪٤٤‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:18 PM‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ‪ DVD‬ﻓﻲ ﻧﺴﺒﺔ ‪ ،4:3‬ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺗﻪ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﻳﻀﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻷﻥ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ DVD‬ﻣﺴﺠﻠﺔ ﻓﻲ ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻤﺎﺕ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻔﺔ‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺑﺎﺧﺘﻼﻑ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺴﺐ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻧﺎﻣﺞ‪ ،‬ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺿﺒﻂ‬
‫ﻧﺴﺒﺔ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ‪ ،HDMI‬ﺗﺘﺤﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪) Wide‬ﺍﻟﻌﺮﻳﺾ( ﺁﻟﻴﺎ‪.‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪SELECT‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺗﻀﺒﻂ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻭﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ »‪ «7890‬ﺍﻓﺘﺮﺍﺿﻴﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺫﺍ ﻧﺴﻴﺖ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻭﺭ ﻟﻤﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺘﻘﺪﻳﺮ‪ ،‬ﻗﻢ ﺑﺎﻵﺗﻲ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐّﻞ ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪) No Disc‬ﻻ ﻳﻮﺟﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ(‪ ،‬ﺍﻣﺴﻚ ﺯﺭ ‪) STOP‬ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ( )¦( ﺑﻤﺸﻐّﻞ ‪ DVD‬ﻟﻤﺪﺓ ﺃﻃﻮﻝ ﻣﻦ ‪ ٥‬ﺛﻮﺍﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ‪ INITIAL‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﻭﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﺮﺟﻊ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻟﻀﻮﺍﺑﻂ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﻢ ﺍﻻﻓﺘﺮﺍﺿﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) POWER‬ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ(‪.‬‬
‫ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪) RESET‬ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ(‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﻣﺤﻮ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻟﻀﻮﺍﺑﻂ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺰﻧﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻻ ﺗﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺜﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺤﺎﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﻀﺮﻭﺭﻳﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪٤٥‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 44-45‬‬
‫ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﻭﺿﻊ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ‪DVD‬‬
‫ﺑﻌﺾ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ DVD-Audio‬ﺗﺤﺘﻮﻱ ﻋﻠﻰ ‪ DVD-Video‬ﻋﻼﻭﺓ ‪.DVD-Audio‬‬
‫ﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺟﺰء ‪ DVD-Viedo‬ﻟﻘﺮﺹ ‪ ،DVD-Audio‬ﺍﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪.DVD-Video‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﻭﺭﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭ‬
‫‪ .١‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) MENU‬ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ(‪.‬‬
‫‪G‬‬
‫ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﻗﺮﺹ ‪ DVD‬ﺃﻭ ‪ ،JPEG CD‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﺮﻳﺪﻫﺎ ﻛﻮﺭﻕ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺭﺍﻥ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪) Setup‬ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ( ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫● ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪) DVD TYPE‬ﻧﻮﻉ ‪ (DVD‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ S,T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪ DVD VIDEO‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‬
‫‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ( )PAUSE‬ﺍﻟﺘﻮﻗﻒ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﻗﺖ(‬
‫ﻋﻨﺪ ﻇﻬﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﻌﺠﺒﻚ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﺿﺒﻂ ﺧﻄﻮﺍﺕ ‪ 4 ~ 1‬ﻣﺮﺓ ﺛﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﺍﺫﺍ ﺃﺭﺩﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻮﻳﻞ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ‪.DVD AUDIO‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) LOGO‬ﺍﻟﺮﻣﺰ(‪.‬‬
‫• ‪ : DVD VIDEO‬ﺍﺿﺒﻂ ﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻣﺤﺘﻮﻳﺎﺕ ‪ DVD Video‬ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﻮﺟﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺮﺹ ‪DVD‬‬
‫‪.Audio‬‬
‫• ‪ : DVD AUDIO‬ﺍﺿﺒﻂ ﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ‪ DVD Audio‬ﺍﻻﻓﺘﺮﺍﺿﻲ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ‪) COPY LOGO DATA‬ﻧﺴﺦ ﺑﻴﺎﻧﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﺰ( ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﺘﻮﻗﻒ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻎﻳﻠﻬﺎ ﻣﺮﺓ ﺛﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ﻭﺭﻕ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺭﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺘﺎﺭﺓ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ‪ 3‬ﺿﻮﺍﺑﻂ ﻟﻮﺭﻕ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺭﺍﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺤﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ‪.‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪COPY LOGO DATA‬‬
‫‪ PAUSE‬‬
‫‪LOGO IS COPIED‬‬
‫‪ PAUSE‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻳﻀﺒﻂ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ‪ DVD‬ﻋﻠﻰ ‪ DVD Audio‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﻫﻮ ﻣﻀﺒﻮﻁ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻤﺼﻨﻊ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻋﻨﺪ ﻗﻄﻊ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻮﻳﻞ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪ DVD Audio‬ﺁﻟﻴﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﺗﺴﺠﻴﻞ )‪DivX( R‬‬
‫ﻳﺮﺟﻰ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺭﻣﺰ ﺍﻟﺘﺴﺠﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺗﺴﺠﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐّﻞ ﻣﻊ ‪ DivX (R) Video‬ﺑﺎﻟﺘﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺏ‪ .‬ﻟﻠﺘﻌﺮﻑ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ‪ ،‬ﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺑـ ‪www.divx.‬‬
‫‪com/vod‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﻭﺿﻊ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻟﻦ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺧﺮﺝ ‪ HDMI 720p، 1080i‬ﺃﻭ ‪.1080p‬‬
‫ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﻹﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺠﺎﺑﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺩﺩ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺁﻟﻴﺎ ﺍﻋﺘﻤﺎﺩﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﺸﻜﻴﻞ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺹ ﺑﻚ ﻭﻣﺎ ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻣﺴﺘﺨﺪﻣﺔ ﺃﻡ ﻻ‪.‬‬
‫ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ‪ 3‬ﺿﻮﺍﺑﻂ ﻟﻮﺭﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭ‬
‫‪ .١‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) MENU‬ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪ Audio‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ENTER‬‬
‫)ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) MENU‬ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﻓﻲ ‪) SPEAKER SETUP‬ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ(‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‬
‫ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪ W‬ﻣﺮﺓ ﺛﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪) Setup‬ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ( ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ S,T,W,X‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺏ ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪) LOGO‬ﺍﻟﺮﻣﺰ( ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‬
‫‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ S,T‬ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ‪) USER‬ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ( ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫• ﻳﺘﻢ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ‪ ٣‬ﺷﺎﺷﺎﺕ ﻟﻮﺭﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٥‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) EXIT‬ﺍﻟﺨﺮﻭﺝ( ﻣﻦ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ‪.‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) RETURN‬ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩﺓ( ﻟﻠﺮﺟﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻖ ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) EXIT‬ﺍﻟﺨﺮﻭﺝ( ﻟﻠﺨﺮﻭﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ‪.‬‬
‫‪٤٦‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:19 PM‬‬
‫• ﻟﻤﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ‪ ،‬ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻲ ﺍﻟﻴﺴﺎﺭ ﻭﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻲ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻴﻦ‪ ،‬ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ‪ ،‬ﻳﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻊ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﻌﺎﻗﺐ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﻠﻲ ‪) SMALL :‬ﺻﻐﻴﺮ( ← ‪) NONE‬ﻻ ﺷﻲء(‪.‬‬
‫• ﻟﻤﺒﻜﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻲ ﺍﻟﻴﺴﺎﺭ ﻭﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻲ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻴﻦ‪ ،‬ﻳﺘﻢ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻊ ﻋﻠﻰ ‪SMALL‬‬
‫)ﺻﻐﻴﺮ(‪.‬‬
‫• ‪) SMALL‬ﺻﻐﻴﺮ( ‪ :‬ﺍﺧﺘﺮﻫﺎ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‪.‬‬
‫• ‪) NONE‬ﻻ ﺷﻲء( ‪ :‬ﺍﺧﺘﺮﻫﺎ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻋﺪﻡ ﺗﺮﻛﻴﺐ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‪.‬‬
‫• ‪ : ORIGINAL‬ﺍﺧﺘﺮ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻟﺮﻣﺰ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ ﻛﻮﺭﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺭﺍﻥ‪.‬‬
‫• ‪ : USER‬ﺍﺧﺘﺮ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻏﻮﺏ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻛﻮﺭﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺭﺍﻥ‪.‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪SELECT‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪CHANGE‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) RETURN‬ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩﺓ( ﻟﻠﺮﺟﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻖ ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) EXIT‬ﺍﻟﺨﺮﻭﺝ( ﻟﻠﺨﺮﻭﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ‪.‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺴﺐ ﺿﻮﺍﺑﻂ ‪ PRO LOGIC‬ﻭ‪ ،STEREO‬ﻗﺪ ﻳﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻭﺿﻊ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ )ﺍﻧﻈﺮ ﺻﻔﺤﺔ ‪.(٥٣‬‬
‫‪٤٧‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 46-47‬‬
‫ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﻧﺒﺮﺓ ﺍﻻﺧﺘﺒﺎﺭ‬
‫ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻣﻴﺰﺓ ﻧﺒﺮﺓ ﺍﻻﺧﺘﺒﺎﺭ ﻟﻔﺤﺺ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻼﺕ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) MENU‬ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ(‪.‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺟﻴﻞ‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪ Audio‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ENTER‬‬
‫)ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫ﺍﺫﺍ ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻀﻊ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺑﺎﻟﻤﺴﺎﻓﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﺴﺎﻭﻳﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻮﻗﻊ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻤﺎﻉ‪ ،‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺿﺒﻂ ﻭﻗﺖ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺟﻴﻞ ﻟﻺﺷﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺗﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻳﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪) DELAY TIME‬ﻭﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺟﻴﻞ( ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ S,T,W,X‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺏ ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٥‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ W,X‬ﻟﻀﺒﻂ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺟﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺿﺒﻂ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺟﻴﻞ ﻟﻤﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺑﻴﻦ ‪ 00‬ﻭ‪ mSEC 05‬ﻭﻟﻤﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻴﻂ ﺍﻟﻴﺴﺎﺭ ﻭﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻴﻂ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻴﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺑﻴﻦ ‪ 00‬ﻭ‪.mSEC 15‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) RETURN‬ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩﺓ( ﻟﻠﺮﺟﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻖ ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) EXIT‬ﺍﻟﺨﺮﻭﺝ( ﻟﻠﺨﺮﻭﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ‪.‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫● ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ‬
‫‪ .١‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) MENU‬ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪ Audio‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ENTER‬‬
‫)ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪) TEST TONE‬ﻧﺒﺮﺓ ﺍﻻﺧﺘﺒﺎﺭ( ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫• ﻧﺒﺮﺓ ﺍﻻﺧﺘﺒﺎﺭﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﺘﻐﻴﺮ ‪ SW ← SR ← R ← C ← L‬ﺑﻬﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺗﻴﺐ‪.‬‬
‫ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﻣﺮﺓ ﺛﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻓﻲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﺘﻮﻗﻒ ﻧﺒﺮﺓ ﺍﻻﺧﺘﺒﺎﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) RETURN‬ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩﺓ( ﻟﻠﺮﺟﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻖ ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) EXIT‬ﺍﻟﺨﺮﻭﺝ( ﻟﻠﺨﺮﻭﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ‪.‬‬
‫‪STOP‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺍﺯﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﻟﻜﻞ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺻﻮﺕ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) MENU‬ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ(‪.‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺟﻴﻞ ﻟﻤﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻴﻂ ﻟﻘﻨﺎﺓ ‪ ،٥٫١‬ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﻟﻚ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻤﺘﺎﻉ ﺑﺼﻮﺕ ﺃﻓﻀﻞ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺎﻓﺔ ﺑﻴﻨﻚ ﻭﺑﻴﻦ ﻛﻞ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺻﻮﺕ ﻣﺘﺴﺎﻭﻳﺔ‪ .‬ﻷﻥ ﻭﻗﺖ ﻭﺻﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻰ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻄﻘﺔ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻤﺎﻉ ﻳﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻃﺒﻘﺎ ﻟﻤﻜﺎﻥ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‪ ،‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺿﺒﻂ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻻﺧﺘﻼﻑ ﻋﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺇﺿﺎﻓﺔ ﺗﺄﺛﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺟﻴﻞ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻟﻤﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ ﻭﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻲ‪.‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ‬
‫ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﺴﺎﻓﺔ ‪ Dc‬ﻣﺘﺴﺎﻭﻳﺔ ﺃﻭ ﺃﻃﻮﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﻓﺔ ‪ Df‬ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺸﻜﻞ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻊ ﻋﻠﻰ ‪٠‬‬
‫)ﺻﻔﺮ( ﻣﺲ‪ .‬ﻭﺇﻻ‪ ،‬ﻗﻢ ﺑﺘﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ ﻃﺒﻘﺎ ﻟﻠﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻣﺴﺎﻓﺔ ﺑﻴﻦ ‪ Df‬ﻭ‪Dc‬‬
‫‪0.00‬‬
‫‪m‬‬
‫‪0.34‬‬
‫‪m‬‬
‫‪0.68‬‬
‫‪m‬‬
‫‪1.06‬‬
‫‪m‬‬
‫‪1.40‬‬
‫‪m‬‬
‫‪m 1.76‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺟﻴﻞ‬
‫‪ms 0‬‬
‫‪ms 1‬‬
‫‪ms 2‬‬
‫‪ms 3‬‬
‫‪ms 4‬‬
‫‪ms 5‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪ Audio‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ENTER‬‬
‫)ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪) SOUND EDIT‬ﺗﺤﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ( ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ S,T‬ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻤﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺑﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ W,X‬ﻟﻀﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻀﻮﺍﺑﻂ‪.‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫ﺃﻓﻀﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﻗﻊ ﻟﻤﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) RETURN‬ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩﺓ( ﻟﻠﺮﺟﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻖ ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) EXIT‬ﺍﻟﺨﺮﻭﺝ( ﻟﻠﺨﺮﻭﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ‪.‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪CHANGE‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻲ‬
‫ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﺴﺎﻓﺔ ‪ Df‬ﻣﺘﺴﺎﻭﻳﺔ ﻣﻊ ﻣﺴﺎﻓﺔ ‪ Ds‬ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺸﻜﻞ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻊ ﻋﻠﻰ ‪) ٠‬ﺻﻔﺮ(‬
‫ﻣﺲ‪ .‬ﻭﺇﻻ‪ ،‬ﻗﻢ ﺑﺘﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ ﻃﺒﻘﺎ ﻟﻠﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻣﺴﺎﻓﺔ ﺑﻴﻦ ‪ Df‬ﻭ‪Dc‬‬
‫‪0.00‬‬
‫‪m‬‬
‫‪1.06‬‬
‫‪m‬‬
‫‪2.11‬‬
‫‪m‬‬
‫‪3.17‬‬
‫‪m‬‬
‫‪4.23‬‬
‫‪m‬‬
‫‪5.29‬‬
‫‪m‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺟﻴﻞ‬
‫‪ms 0‬‬
‫‪ms 3‬‬
‫‪ms 6‬‬
‫‪ms 9‬‬
‫‪ms 12‬‬
‫‪ms 15‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪٤٨‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:20 PM‬‬
‫ﺃﻓﻀﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﻗﻊ ﻟﻤﻜﺒﺮ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ‬
‫ﻳﻮﺻﻰ ﺑﺄﻥ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ ﺗﻀﻊ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺤﻠﻘﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪ : Df‬ﻣﺴﺎﻓﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻲ‬
‫‪ : Dc‬ﻣﺴﺎﻓﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ‬
‫‪ : Ds‬ﻣﺴﺎﻓﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻲ‬
‫)‪ ،(Dolby Pro Logic II‬ﻗﺪ ﻳﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺟﻴﻞ ﻟﻜﻞ ﻭﺿﻊ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻣﻊ ‪PL‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻣﻊ ‪ AC-3‬ﻭ‪ ،DTS‬ﻳﻀﺒﻂ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺟﻴﻞ ﺑﻴﻦ ‪ 00‬ﻭ‪.15mSEC‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺍﻟﻘﻨﺎﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻳﺔ ﻗﺎﺑﻠﺔ ﻟﻠﻀﺒﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ﻗﻨﺎﺓ ‪.5.1‬‬
‫‪٤٩‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 48-49‬‬
‫ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﺗﺰﺍﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ‬
‫ﻗﺪ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺃﺑﻄﺄ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐّﻞ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ‪ .‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﺣﺪﺙ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﺒﻂ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺗﺄﺟﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻟﻠﻤﻮﺍﻓﻘﺔ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻟﻤﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻮﺍﺯﻥ ﻳﺪﻭﻳﺎ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺯﺭ ‪) SOUND EDIT‬ﺗﺤﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ(‬
‫‪ .١‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) MENU‬ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪ Audio‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ENTER‬‬
‫)ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪ AV-SYNC‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ENTER‬‬
‫)ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ S,T‬ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺗﺄﺟﻴﻞ ‪ AV-SYNC‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‬
‫‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻀﺒﻂ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺗﺄﺟﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺑﻴﻦ ‪ ٠‬ﻣﺲ ﻭ‪ ٣٠٠‬ﻣﺲ‪ .‬ﺍﺿﺒﻄﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻓﻀﻞ ﺍﻟﺤﺎﻟﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫● ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) SOUND EDIT‬ﺗﺤﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ( ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪. W,X‬‬
‫• ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ ،SOUND EDIT‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺍﺯﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﻟﻜﻞ‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) RETURN‬ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩﺓ( ﻟﻠﺮﺟﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻖ ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) EXIT‬ﺍﻟﺨﺮﻭﺝ( ﻟﻠﺨﺮﻭﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ‪.‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪SELECT‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﺃﻭﺩﻳﻮ ‪) HDMI‬ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭﻱ(‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺘﺤﻮﻝ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﻘﻮﻟﺔ ﻋﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ‪ HDMI‬ﺍﻟﻰ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ‪.ON/OFF‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﺗﻮﺍﺯﻥ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻲ‪/‬ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻲ‬
‫‪ ‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﻴﻦ ‪ 00‬ﻭ‪ -06‬ﻭﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻳﻨﺨﻔﺾ ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﺘﺤﺮﻙ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ‪.-6‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) MENU‬ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪ Audio‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ENTER‬‬
‫)ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪ HDMI AUDIO‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‬
‫‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ‪/‬ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻲ‪/‬ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ‬
‫‪ ‬ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺿﺒﻂ ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻓﻲ ﺧﻄﻮﺍﺕ ﻣﻦ ‪ dB +6‬ﺍﻟﻰ ‪.-6dB‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻳﺰﻳﺪ ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻘﺘﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ‪ +6dB‬ﻭﻳﻨﺨﻔﺾ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﺒﺘﻌﺪ ﻣﻦ ‪.-6dB‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ S,T‬ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ‪ ON‬ﺃﻭ ‪ OFF‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‬
‫‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ(‪.‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ‪) DRC‬ﺿﻐﻂ ﺍﻟﻨﻄﺎﻕ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﻨﺎﻣﻲ(‬
‫ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺗﻮﺍﺯﻥ ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻯ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺃﻛﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻭﺃﺻﻐﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‪ .‬ﻭﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻟﻼﺳﺘﻤﺘﺎﻉ ﺑﺼﻮﺕ ﺩﻭﻟﺒﻲ ﺭﻗﻤﻲ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﻓﻴﻠﻢ ﻓﻲ ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺻﻮﺕ‬
‫ﻣﻨﺨﻔﺾ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞ‬
‫• ‪ : On‬ﻳﺘﻢ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻭﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ ﻋﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ‪ ،HDMI‬ﻭﻳﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺧﻼﻝ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻟﻠﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻓﻘﻂ‪.‬‬
‫• ‪ : Off‬ﻳﺘﻢ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻋﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ‪ ،HDMI‬ﻭﻳﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻼﻝ‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﺒﻲ ﻓﻘﻂ‪.‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪SELECT‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) MENU‬ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ(‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪ Audio‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ENTER‬‬
‫)ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) RETURN‬ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩﺓ( ﻟﻠﺮﺟﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻖ ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) EXIT‬ﺍﻟﺨﺮﻭﺝ( ﻟﻠﺨﺮﻭﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ‪ T‬ﻟﻼﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻰ ‪) DRC‬ﺿﻐﻂ ﺍﻟﻨﻄﺎﻕ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﻨﺎﻣﻲ( ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) ENTER‬ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ( ﺃﻭ ﺯﺭ ‪W‬‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪S,T‬ﻟﻀﺒﻂ ‪) DRC‬ﺿﻐﻂ ﺍﻟﻨﻄﺎﻕ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﻨﺎﻣﻲ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻤﺴﻚ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ S‬ﻟﻤﺪﺓ ﺃﻃﻮﻝ‪ ،‬ﻳﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺛﻴﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻤﺴﻚ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪ T‬ﻟﻤﺪﺓ‬
‫ﺃﻗﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺛﻴﺮ‪.‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪ENTER‬‬
‫‪MOVE‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ ﺍﻻﻓﺘﺮﺍﺿﻲ ﺍﻟﻤﺼﻨﻌﻲ ﻟﻬﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻫﻮ ‪.HDMI Audio Off‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ‪ HDMI AUDIO‬ﺁﻟﻴﺎ ﻣﻮﺍﻓﻘﺎ ﻣﻊ ﻗﻨﺎﺓ ‪ ٢‬ﻟﻤﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻟﻠﺘﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) RETURN‬ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩﺓ( ﻟﻠﺮﺟﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻖ ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) EXIT‬ﺍﻟﺨﺮﻭﺝ( ﻟﻠﺨﺮﻭﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ‪.‬‬
‫‪EXIT‬‬
‫‪٥٠‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:20 PM‬‬
‫‪RETURN‬‬
‫‪CHANGE‬‬
‫‪٥١‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 50-51‬‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻧﻄﺎﻕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ )‪ / (DSP‬ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺍﺯﻥ‬
‫‪) DSP‬ﻣﻌﺎﻟﺞ ﺍﻹﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ( ‪ :‬ﺗﻢ ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﺃﻭﺿﺎﻉ ‪ DSP‬ﻟﺘﻈﺎﻫﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺌﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺗﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ‬
‫ﻭﺿﻊ ‪) DOLBY PRO LOGIC II‬ﺩﻭﻟﺒﻲ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﻄﻘﻲ ﺍﻻﺣﺘﺮﺍﻓﻲ ‪(2‬‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺩﻭﻟﺒﻲ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﻄﻘﻲ ﺍﻻﺣﺘﺮﺍﻓﻲ ‪ ٢‬ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺗﻲ‪.‬‬
‫‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪PL II MODE‬‬
‫• ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ‪ ،‬ﻳﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻊ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﻠﻲ ‪:‬‬
‫‪MUSIC ➞ CINEMA ➞ PRO LOGIC ➞ MATRIX ➞STEREO ➞ MUSIC‬‬
‫‪) EQ‬ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺍﺯﻥ( ‪ :‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ‪) ROCK‬ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻙ(‪) POP ،‬ﺍﻟﺒﻮﺏ(‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ‪) CLASSIC‬ﺍﻟﻜﻼﺳﻴﻜﻲ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺴﺐ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺳﻴﻘﻰ‪.‬‬
‫● ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪.DSP/EQ‬‬
‫• ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ‪) DSP‬ﻣﻌﺎﻟﺞ ﺍﻹﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ‪.‬‬
‫ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ‪ ،‬ﻳﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﺨﻴﺎﺭ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﻠﻲ ‪:‬‬
‫‪POPS ➞ JAZZ ➞ ROCK ➞ STUDIO ➞ CLUB ➞ HALL ➞ MOVIE ➞ CHURCH ➞ PASS‬‬
‫•‬
‫•‬
‫•‬
‫•‬
‫•‬
‫•‬
‫•‬
‫‪ : POP، JAZZ، ROCK‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻦ ‪) POP‬ﺍﻟﺒﻮﺏ(‪) JAZZ ،‬ﺍﻟﺠﺎﺯ(‪ ،‬ﻭ‪) rock‬ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻙ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺴﺐ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺳﻴﻘﻰ‪.‬‬
‫‪ : STUDIO‬ﻳﻌﻄﻴﻚ ﺇﺣﺴﺎﺱ ﺑﺄﻧﻚ ﻓﻲ ﺍﺳﺘﻴﺪﻳﻮ‪.‬‬
‫‪ : CLUB‬ﻳﺘﻔﺎﻋﻞ ﺻﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻬﻲ ﻣﻊ ﺻﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﻴﻖ‪.‬‬
‫‪ : HALL‬ﻳﺰﻭﺩ ﺑﺼﻮﺕ ﻭﺍﺿﺢ ﻛﺄﻧﻚ ﻓﻲ ﺻﺎﻟﺔ ﻣﻮﺳﻴﻘﻰ‪.‬‬
‫‪ : MOVIE‬ﻳﺰﻭﺩ ﺑﺈﺣﺴﺎﺱ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ‪.‬‬
‫‪ : CHURCH‬ﻳﺰﻭﺩ ﺑﺄﻧﻚ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﻛﻨﻴﺴﺔ ﻛﺒﻴﺮﺓ‪.‬‬
‫‪ : PASS‬ﺍﺧﺘﺮ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻟﻼﺳﺘﻤﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺩﻱ‪.‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪ DSP/EQ‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪.STEREO‬‬
‫‪ PL II mode‬ﻟﻌﺮﺽ ‪ SHOW‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‬
‫‪ ‬ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻓﻲ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ CD، MP3-CD، DVD-Audio‬ﺑﻘﻨﺎﺓ ‪ DivX ،2‬ﻭﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ﺩﻭﻟﺒﻲ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻗﺮﺹ ‪ DVD‬ﻣﺸﻔﺮ ﺑﻘﻨﺎﺗﻴﻦ ﺃﻭ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﻘﻨﺎﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻌﺪﺩﺓ ﺗﻠﻘﺎﺋﻴﺎ ﻭﻻ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪.DSP/EQ‬‬
‫‪PRO LOGIC II‬‬
‫•‬
‫•‬
‫•‬
‫•‬
‫•‬
‫‪ : MUSIC‬ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻤﺎﻉ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺳﻴﻘﻰ‪ ،‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺮﻑ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﺄﺛﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻛﺄﻧﻚ ﺗﺴﺘﻤﻊ ﺇﻟﻰ ﻣﻮﺳﻴﻘﻲ ﺣﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪ : CINEMA‬ﺗﻀﻴﻒ ﺣﻴﻮﻳﺔ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﺪﺭﺝ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺗﻲ ﻟﻠﻔﻴﻠﻢ‪.‬‬
‫‪ : PRO LOGIC‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﺘﻌﺮﻑ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﺄﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﺘﻌﺪﺩ ﻟﻘﻨﺎﺓ ﺣﻘﻴﻘﻴﺔ ﻛﺄﻧﻚ ﺗﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻤﺲ‪ ،‬ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﻱ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻲ ﺍﻟﻴﺴﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﻴﻤﻴﻦ ﻓﻘﻂ‪.‬‬
‫‪ : MATRIX‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﺴﺘﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻴﻂ ﻟﻘﻨﺎﺓ ‪.5.1‬‬
‫‪ : STEREO‬ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺮ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻟﻼﺗﺴﻤﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﻱ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻲ ﺍﻟﻴﺴﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﻴﻤﻴﻦ ﻭﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ ﻓﻘﻂ‪.‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪ ،Pro Logic II‬ﻗﻢ ﺑﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻲ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺹ ﺑﻚ ﺍﻟﻰ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﺲ ‪) AUDIO INPUT‬ﺍﻟﻴﺴﺎﺭ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻴﻤﻴﻦ( ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺟﻮﺩﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻟﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐّﻞ‪ .‬ﺇﺫﺍ ﻭﺻﻠﺖ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺍ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﺲ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺧﻞ )ﺍﻟﻴﺴﺎﺭ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻴﻦ(‪ ،‬ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻤﺎﻉ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻴﻂ ﻟﻘﻨﺎﺓ ‪.5.1‬‬
‫ﺗﺄﺛﻴﺮ ‪) DOLBY PRO LOGIC II‬ﺩﻭﻟﺒﻲ ﺍﻝﻣﻨﻄﻘﻲ ﺍﻻﺣﺘﺮﺍﻓﻲ ‪(2‬‬
‫ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪ Dolby Pro Logic MUSIC‬ﻓﻘﻂ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪PL II MODE‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪PL II EFFECT‬‬
‫ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪) MUSIC‬ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺳﻴﻘﻰ(‪.‬‬
‫‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ ‪W,X‬ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺛﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺏ‪.‬‬
‫• ‪ : PANORAMA‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﻴﻦ ‪) 0‬ﺻﻔﺮ( ﺍﻟﻰ ‪.1‬‬
‫• ‪ : C-WIDTH‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﻴﻦ ‪) 0‬ﺻﻔﺮ( ﺍﻟﻰ ‪.7‬‬
‫• ‪ : DIMENSION‬ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﻴﻦ ‪) 0‬ﺻﻔﺮ( ﺍﻟﻰ ‪.6‬‬
‫‪٥٢‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:21 PM‬‬
‫‪٥٣‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 52-53‬‬
‫ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻤﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺩﻳﻮ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻮﻇﺎﺋﻒ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻳﺤﺔ‬
‫ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺩﻳﻮ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻮﻇﺎﺋﻒ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻳﺤﺔ‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﺘﻮﻗﻒ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺰﻟﻲ ﺑﻨﻔﺴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺧﺘﺮ ﻣﺤﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﺚ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺑﺔ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺍﻟﻔﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﺗﻮﻣﺎﺗﻴﻜﻴﺔ ‪ : ١‬ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‪ #,$‬ﻳﺘﻢ‬
‫ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﺤﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﺚ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺒﻖ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺍﻟﻔﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﺗﻮﻣﺎﺗﻴﻜﻴﺔ ‪ : ٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻭﺍﻣﺴﻚ ﺯﺭ ‪ .,,‬ﻟﻜﺸﻒ‬
‫ﻣﺤﻄﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺒﺚ ﺍﻟﻔﻌﻠﻲ ﺃﻭﺗﻮﻣﺎﺗﻴﻜﻴﺎ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺍﻟﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﻴﺪﻭﻳﺔ ‪ :‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‪ .,,‬ﺑﺎﻹﻳﺠﺎﺯ ﻟﺰﻳﺎﺩﺓ ﺃﻭ ﺧﻔﺾ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺩﺩﺍﺕ ﺇﺿﺎﻓﻴﺎ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ‪ .SLEEP‬ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﻳﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺒﻖ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ ﻛﻤﺎ‬
‫ﻳﻠﻲ ‪:‬‬
‫‪ ← 150 ← 120 ← 90 ← 60 ← 30 ← 20 ← 10‬ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ‬
‫● ﺍﻟﻮﻇﺎﺋﻒ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻳﺤﺔ‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) TUNER‬ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺍﻟﻒ( ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻮﺟﺔ ‪.FM‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) SLEEP‬ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻡ(‪.‬‬
‫ﻟﺘﺄﻛﻴﺪ ﻣﺆﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) SLEEP‬ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻡ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﺒﻘﻲ ﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺘﺎﺭ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﻐﻴّﺮ ﺍﻟﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﻣﺮﺓ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ ﺍﻻﺧﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻹﻟﻐﺎء ﻣﺆﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) SLEEP‬ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻡ( ﺣﺘﻰ ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ‪ OFF‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) FUNCTION‬ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ( ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻮﺟﺔ ‪.FM‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺧﺘﺮ ﻣﺤﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﺚ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺍﻟﻔﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﺗﻮﻣﺎﺗﻴﻜﻴﺔ ‪ : ١‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) STOP‬ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ( )‪ (‬ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ‬
‫‪) PRESET‬ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺒﻖ(‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‪ #,$‬ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ‬
‫ﻣﺤﻄﺔ ﻣﺨﺰﻧﺔ ﻣﺴﺒﻘﺔ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺍﻟﻔﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﺗﻮﻣﺎﺗﻴﻜﻴﺔ ‪ : ٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) STOP‬ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ( )‪ (‬ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ‬
‫‪) MANUAL‬ﺍﻟﻴﺪﻭﻱ(‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻭﺍﻣﺴﻚ ﺯﺭ ‪ #,$‬ﻟﻜﺸﻒ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺟﺔ ﺃﻭﺗﻮﻣﺎﺗﻴﻜﻴﺎ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺍﻟﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﻴﺪﻭﻳﺔ ‪ :‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) STOP‬ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ( )‪ (‬ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪) MANUAL‬ﺍﻟﻴﺪﻭﻱ(‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‪#,$‬‬
‫ﺑﺎﻹﻳﺠﺎﺯ ﻟﻤﺆﺍﻟﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺩﺩﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﺗﻔﻌﺔ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺨﻔﻀﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) MO/ST‬ﺍﻷﺣﺎﺩﻱ‪/‬ﺍﻟﺴﺘﻴﺮﻳﻮ( ﻟﻼﺳﺘﻤﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻷﺣﺎﺩﻱ‪/‬ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻴﺮﻳﻮ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﺘﺤﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺑﻴﻦ ‪ STEREO‬ﻭ‪ MONO‬ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻓﻲ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﺔ ﺿﻌﻒ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻘﺒﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﺍﺧﺘﺮ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪) MONO‬ﺍﻷﺣﺎﺩﻱ( ﻟﻠﺒﺚ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺿﺢ ﺑﺪﻭﻥ ﺍﻟﺘﺪﺍﺧﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﺿﺒﻂ ﺳﻄﻮﻉ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ‬
‫ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺿﺒﻂ ﻧﺼﻮﻉ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ ﺩﻭﻥ ﻣﻀﺎﻳﻘﺘﻚ ﻟﻤﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﻠﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) DIMMER‬ﺍﻟﻤﻌﺘﺎﻡ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ‪ ،‬ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺳﻄﻮﻉ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻛﺘﻢ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﻣﻔﻴﺪﺓ ﻟﻠﺮﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﺮﺱ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺏ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻬﺎﺗﻒ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) MUTE‬ﺍﻟﻜﺘﻢ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﻮﻣﺾ ‪ MUTE‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻹﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻷﺻﻠﻲ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) MUTE‬ﻛﺘﻢ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ( ﻣﺮﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻄﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺒﻘﺔ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ‬
‫ﻣﺜﻼ ‪ :‬ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺒﻖ ﻟـ ‪ ٨٩٫١ FM‬ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺬﺍﻛﺮﺓ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺠﻬﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻱ‬
‫ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻱ ﺗﻌﺰﺯ ﺻﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﻴﺮ ﻟﻜﻲ ﻳﺼﺒﺢ ﻗﻮﻳﺎ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) TUNER‬ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺍﻟﻒ( ﻭﺍﺧﺘﺮ ﻣﻮﺟﺔ ‪.FM‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‪.,,‬ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ »‪.«٨٩٫١٠‬‬
‫‪ .١‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) P.BASS‬ﺍﻟﺠﻬﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻱ( ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪.P.BASS‬‬
‫‪ .٣‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) TUNER MEMORY‬ﺫﺍﻛﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺍﻟﻒ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﻮﻣﺾ ‪ 01‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ‪.‬‬
‫‪ .٢‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) P.BASS‬ﺍﻟﺠﻬﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻱ( ﻣﺮﺓ ﺛﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ‬
‫ﻭﺿﻊ ‪.P. BASS‬‬
‫‪ .٤‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ #,$‬ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺒﻖ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻦﻙ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﻴﻦ ‪ 1‬ﻭ‪.15‬‬
‫‪ .٥‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) TUNER MEMORY‬ﺫﺍﻛﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺍﻟﻒ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ TUNER MEMORY‬ﻗﺒﻞ ﺗﻼﺷﻲ ‪Number‬‬
‫)ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻢ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﺘﻼﺷﻰ ‪) Number‬ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻢ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﻭﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺨﺰﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻄﺔ‬
‫ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺬﺍﻛﺮﺓ‪.‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪) P.BASS‬ﺍﻟﺠﻬﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻱ( ﻣﻊ ﻣﺼﺎﺩﺭ ‪ LPCM‬ﺑﻘﻨﺎﺓ ‪ 2‬ﻣﺜﻞ ‪ MP3، DivX، CD‬ﻭ‪ .WMA‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ‬
‫‪ P.BASS‬ﻭﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ »‪ «POWER BASS ON‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻻ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪) P.BASS‬ﺍﻟﺠﻬﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻱ( ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪ DSP/EQ‬ﺃﻭ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪ .DOLBY PRO LOGIC II‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﺿﻐﻄﺖ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ P.BASS‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪ ،DSP/EQ‬ﻳﻐﻠﻖ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪ DSP/EQ‬ﺁﻟﻴﺎ ﻭﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪.P.BASS‬‬
‫‪ .٦‬ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺍﻟﻀﺐﻁ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺒﻖ ﻟﻤﺤﻄﺔ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ‪ ،‬ﻗﻢ ﺑﺘﻜﺮﺍﺭ ﺧﻄﻮﺍﺕ ‪ 2‬ﺍﻟﻰ ‪.5‬‬
‫• ﻟﻤﺆﺍﻟﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺒﻘﺔ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ‪ ،‬ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪ #,$‬ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻘﻨﺎﺓ‪.‬‬
‫‪٥٤‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:22 PM‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻻ ﺗﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺇﺫﺍﻋﺔ ‪.AM‬‬
‫‪٥٥‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 54-55‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ‬
‫ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺃﺩﻧﺎﻩ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻻ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺑﺸﻜﻞ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ‪ .‬ﺍﺫﺍ ﻟﻢ ﺗﺠﺪ ﺣﻼ ﻟﻠﻤﺸﻜﻠﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﺟﻬﻬﺎ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺃﺩﻧﺎﻩ ﺃﻭ ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﻠﻴﻤﺎﺕ ﺃﺩﻧﺎﻩ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﻔﻴﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭﻗﻒ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ‪،‬‬
‫ﺍﻓﺼﻠﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ ﻣﺼﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺑﺄﻗﺮﺏ ﻭﻛﻴﻞ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪ ﺃﻭ ﻣﺮﻛﺰ ﺧﺪﻣﺔ ﻟﺴﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺮﻭﻧﻴﻜﺲ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ‬
‫ﻻ ﺃﺳﺘﻄﻴﻊ ﺇﺧﺮﺍﺝ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﻻ ﻳﺪﻭﺭ ﻭﻻ ﺗﻮﺟﺪ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻫﻞ ﺗﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ؟‬
‫• ﻧﻮﻋﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺟﻴﺪﺓ ﻭﺑﻬﺎ ﺍﻫﺘﺰﺍﺯ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻫﻞ ﺗﻢ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻛﻮﺍﺑﻞ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺑﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺻﺤﻴﺤﺔ؟‬
‫• ﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﻣﺘﺴﺦ ﺃﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻠﻒ؟‬
‫• ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﻳﺸﻐّﻞ ﻗﺮﺹ ﺳﻴﺊ ﺍﻹﻧﺘﺎﺝ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﺤﺺ‪/‬ﺍﻹﺻﻼﺡ‬
‫• ﻫﻞ ﺗﻢ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺳﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺮﺝ ﺑﺈﺣﻜﺎﻡ؟‬
‫ﻻ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺣﺘﻰ ﻟﻮ ﺗﻢ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻫﻞ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻣﺖ ﻗﺮﺹ ﻻ ﻳﺤﺘﻮﻱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﻮﺍﺋﻢ؟‬
‫ﻻ ﻳﺒﺪﺃ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﻧﺴﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ DVD 16:9‬ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪ ،WIDE 16:9‬ﻭﺿﻊ ‪LETTER 4:3‬‬
‫‪ ،BOX‬ﺃﻭ ﻭﺿﻊ ‪ ،PAN SCAN 4:3‬ﻟﻜﻦ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ‪ DVD 4:3‬ﻓﻲ ﻧﺴﺒﺔ ‪ 4:3‬ﻓﻘﻂ‪.‬‬
‫ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﻏﻼﻑ ﻗﺮﺹ ‪ DVD‬ﻭﺍﺧﺘﺮ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺎﺳﺒﺔ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ‪ CD-ROM‬ﻭ‪ DVD-ROM‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺸﻐّﻞ ‪.DVD‬‬
‫• ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺘﻘﺪﻳﺮ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻫﻞ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻣﺖ ﻗﺮﺻﺎ ﻣﺸﻮﻫﺎ ﺃﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺧﺪﻭﺵ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﻄﺤﻪ؟‬
‫ﻻ ﻳﺒﺪﺃ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻴﻐﻞ ﻓﻮﺭﺍ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻟﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪PLAY/‬‬
‫‪.PAUSE‬‬
‫• ﺍﻣﺴﺢ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﻟﻠﺘﻨﻈﻴﻒ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻻ ﻳﺨﺮﺝ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻻ ﻳﻮﺟﺪ ﺻﻮﺕ ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﻳﻊ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﻲء‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺤﺮﻛﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﻴﺌﺔ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻫﻞ ﺗﻢ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺑﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺻﺤﻴﺤﺔ؟ ﻫﻞ ﺗﻢ ﺗﺮﻛﻴﺐ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺑﺼﻮﺭﺓ‬
‫ﺻﺤﻴﺤﺔ؟‬
‫• ﻻ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ‪) .‬ﻣﺜﻼ ‪ :‬ﺗﻘﻄﻊ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﻭﺧﺮﻭﺝ ﺻﻮﺕ ﻏﺮﻳﺐ‪(.‬‬
‫ﻳﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻣﺒﻜﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻓﻘﻂ‪ ،‬ﻟﻴﺲ‬
‫ﻛﻞ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺴﺘﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻻ ﻳﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻴﻂ ﻟﻘﻨﺎﺓ ‪ 5.1‬ﺩﻭﻟﺒﻲ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺃﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﻭﺃﻣﺴﻚ ﺯﺭ ‪) STOP‬ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ( )‪ (‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ ﻟﻤﺪﺓ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ‪ ٥‬ﺛﻮﺍﻥ )ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﻻ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﻣﺸﻐّﻞ ‪ DVD‬ﺑﺸﻜﻞ ﻋﺎﺩﻱ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪) RESET‬ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ( ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﻤﺤﻮ ﻛﻞ ﻣﺎ ﺗﻢ ﺿﺒﻄﻪ ﻭﺧﺰﻧﻪ‪ .‬ﻻ ﺗﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻫﺬﻩ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺩﻭﻥ ﺣﺎﺟﺔ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻫﻞ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﺿﺮﺭ ﻛﺒﻴﺮ؟‬
‫• ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻤﺎﻉ ﺇﻟﻰ ﻗﺮﺹ ﻣﺪﻣﺞ ﺃﻭ ﺭﺍﺩﻳﻮ‪ ،‬ﻳﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻴﺔ )ﺍﻟﻴﺴﺎﺭ‪/‬‬
‫‪PLII‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻴﻦ( ﻓﻘﻂ‪ .‬ﺍﺧﺘﺮ »‪ «PRO LOGIC II‬ﺑﺎﻟﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪(Dolby Pro‬‬
‫‪ (Logic II‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻛﻞ ﻣﻜﺒﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺴﺘﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻧﺴﻴﺖ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻭﺭ ﻟﻤﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺘﻘﺪﻳﺮ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺃﺛﻨﺎء ﻋﺮﺽ ﺭﺳﺎﻟﺔ »‪ «NO DISC‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﻟﻠﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﻣﺴﻚ ﺯﺭ‬
‫‪)STOP‬ﺍﻹﻳﻘﺎﻑ( )‪ (‬ﻟﻠﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ ﻟﻤﺪﺓ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ‪ ٥‬ﺛﻮﺍﻥ‪ .‬ﻭﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ »‪«INITIIAL‬‬
‫)ﺃﻭﻟﻲ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﻭﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﻌﻮﺩ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻟﻀﻮﺍﺑﻂ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻤﺼﻨﻊ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ ﻗﺮﺹ ‪ DVD‬ﻣﺘﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﻣﻊ ﻗﻨﺎﺓ ‪.5.1‬‬
‫• ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﺭ ‪) POWER‬ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ(‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﺫﺍ ﺿﺒﻄﺖ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ‪ ،‬ﻣﻜﺒﺮﻱ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻲ ﺍﻟﻴﺴﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﻴﻤﻴﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ ‪) NONE‬ﻻ‬
‫ﺷﻲء( ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻓﻲ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ ﻓﻲ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ‪ ،‬ﻻ ﻳﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ ﻭﻣﻜﺒﺮﻱ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻲ ﺍﻟﻴﺴﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﻴﻤﻴﻦ‪ .‬ﺍﺿﺒﻂ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ‪،‬‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮﻱ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻲ ﺍﻟﻴﺴﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﻴﻤﻴﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ ‪) SMALL‬ﺻﻐﻴﺮ(‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ‪) RESET‬ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ( ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﻤﺤﻮ ﻛﻞ ﻣﺎ ﺗﻢ ﺿﺒﻄﻪ ﻭﺧﺰﻧﻪ‪.‬ﻻ ﺗﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻫﺬﻩ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺩﻭﻥ ﺣﺎﺟﺔ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻫﻞ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻋﻼﻣﺔ »‪ «Dolby Digital 5.1 CH‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﻄﺢ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ؟ ﻳﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻴﻂ‬
‫ﻟﻘﻨﺎﺓ ‪ 5.1‬ﺩﻭﻟﺒﻲ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺴﺠﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﺑﺼﻮﺕ ﻗﻨﺎﺓ ‪ 5.1‬ﻓﻘﻂ‪.‬‬
‫● ﺗﺤﺮﻱ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻞ ﻭﺇﺻﻼﺣﻪ‬
‫ﻻ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻟﻐﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻟﻦ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻟﻐﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ ﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ DVD‬ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﻻ ﺗﺤﺘﻮﻱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ‬
‫ﺑﺎﺧﺘﻼﻑ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺴﺐ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺃﻭﻗﻒ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺷﻐّﻠﻬﺎ ﻣﺮﺓ ﺛﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫• ﺍﻓﺤﺺ ﺭﻗﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﻄﻘﺔ ﻟـ ‪ .DVD‬ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ‪ DVD‬ﺍﺷﺘﺮﻳﺘﻬﺎ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺝ‪.‬‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺗﺤﺮﻱ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻞ ﻭﺇﺻﻼﺣﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﺤﺺ‪/‬ﺍﻹﺻﻼﺡ‬
‫ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺍﺳﺘﻘﺒﺎﻝ ﺑﺮﻧﺎﻣﺞ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺩﻳﻮ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻫﻞ ﺗﻢ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻬﻮﺍﺋﻲ ﺑﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺻﺤﻴﺤﺔ؟‬
‫• ﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻬﻮﺍﺋﻲ ﺿﻌﻴﻔﺔ‪ ،‬ﺭﻛّﺐ ﻫﻮﺍﺋﻲ ‪ FM‬ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻲ ﻓﻲ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﺔ ﺟﻴﺪﺓ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻘﺒﺎﻝ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻫﻞ ﺗﻢ ﺿﺒﻂ ﻟﻐﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﻮ ﻋﻠﻰ ‪ DOLBY DIGITAL 5.1 CH‬ﻓﻲ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ؟‬
‫ﻻ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‪.‬‬
‫• ﻫﻞ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﻧﻄﺎﻕ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻟﻠﺰﺍﻭﻳﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻤﺴﺎﻓﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺑﺔ؟‬
‫• ﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺎﺕ ﻣﺴﺘﻨﻔﺪﺓ؟‬
‫• ﻫﻞ ﺍﺧﺘﺮﺕ ﻭﻇﺎﺋﻒ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻊ )‪ (TV/DVD‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ )‪ TV‬ﺃﻭ ‪ (DVD‬ﺑﺼﻮﺭﺓ‬
‫ﺻﺤﻴﺤﺔ؟‬
‫‪٥٦‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:22 PM‬‬
‫‪٥٧‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 56-57‬‬
USB Host ‫ﻣﻨﺘﺠﺎﺕ ﺗﺪﻋﻢ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ‬
(٤٣ ‫ )ﺍﻧﻈﺮ ﺻﻔﺤﺔ‬.‫ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﻭ ﺃﻭ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‬,‫ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﺭﻗﻢ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﺰﺍﻟﻤﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﻟﻠﻀﻮﺍﺑﻂ ﺍﻷﺑﺘﺪﺍﺋﻴﺔ ﺃﻭﺩﻳﻮﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻣﻴﺮﺍ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ‬
‫● ﺍﻟﻤﻠﺤﻘﺎﺕ‬
ARA
‫ﺟﺪﻭﻝ ﺭﻣﺰ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺔ‬
Code
Language
Code
Language
Code
Language
Code
Language
1027
Afar
1181
Frisian
1334
Latvian, Lettish
1506
Slovenian
1028
Abkhazian
1183
Irish
1345
Malagasy
1507
Samoan
1032
Afrikaans
1186
Scots Gaelic
1347
Maori
1508
Shona
1039
Amharic
1194
Galician
1349
Macedonian
1509
Somali
1044
Arabic
1196
Guarani
1350
Malayalam
1511
Albanian
1045
Assamese
1203
Gujarati
1352
Mongolian
1512
Serbian
1051
Aymara
1209
Hausa
1353
Moldavian
1513
Siswati
1052
Azerbaijani
1217
Hindi
1356
Marathi
1514
Sesotho
1053
Bashkir
1226
Croatian
1357
Malay
1515
Sundanese
1057
Byelorussian
1229
Hungarian
1358
Maltese
1516
Swedish
1059
Bulgarian
1233
Armenian
1363
Burmese
1517
Swahili
1060
Bihari
1235
Interlingua
1365
Nauru
1521
Tamil
1069
Bislama
1239
Interlingue
1369
Nepali
1525
Tegulu
1066
Bengali; Bangla
1245
Inupiak
1376
Dutch
1527
Tajik
1067
Tibetan
1248
Indonesian
1379
Norwegian
1528
Thai
1070
Breton
1253
Icelandic
1393
Occitan
1529
Tigrinya
1079
Catalan
1254
Italian
1403
(Afan) Oromo
1531
Turkmen
1093
Corsican
1257
Hebrew
1408
Oriya
1532
Tagalog
1097
Czech
1261
Japanese
1417
Punjabi
1534
Setswana
1103
Welsh
1269
Yiddish
1428
Polish
1535
Tonga
1105
Danish
1283
Javanese
1435
Pashto, Pushto
1538
Turkish
1109
German
1287
Georgian
1436
Portuguese
1539
Tsonga
1130
Bhutani
1297
Kazakh
1463
Quechua
1540
Tatar
1142
Greek
1298
Greenlandic
1481
Rhaeto-Romance
1543
Twi
1144
English
1299
Cambodian
1482
Kirundi
1557
Ukrainian
1145
Esperanto
1300
Kannada
1483
Romanian
1564
Urdu
1149
Spanish
1301
Korean
1489
Russian
1572
Uzbek
1150
Estonian
1305
Kashmiri
1491
Kinyarwanda
1581
Vietnamese
1151
Basque
1307
Kurdish
1495
Sanskrit
1587
Volapuk
1157
Persian
1311
Kirghiz
1498
Sindhi
1613
Wolof
1165
Finnish
1313
Latin
1501
Sangro
1632
Xhosa
1166
Fiji
1326
Lingala
1502
Serbo-Croatian
1665
Yoruba
1171
Faeroese
1327
Laothian
1503
Singhalese
1684
Chinese
1174
French
1332
Lithuanian
1505
Slovak
1697
Zulu
٥٩
HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 58-59
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻛﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻉ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻛﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻉ‬
Finepix-A340
Finepix-F810
Finepix-F610
Finepix-f450
Finepix S7000
Finepix A310
KD-310Z
Finecam SL300R
Finecam SL400R
Finecam S5R
Finecam Xt
Dimage-Z1
Dimage Z1
Dimage X21
Coolpix4200
Coolpix4300
Coolpix 2200
Coolpix 3500
Coolpix 3700
Coolpix 4100
Coolpix 5200
Stylus 410 digital
300-digital
300-digital
Fuji
Fuji
Fuji
Fuji
Fuji
Fuji
Konica
Kyocera
Kyocera
Kyocera
Kyocera
Minolta
Minolta
Minolta
Nikon
Nikon
Nikon
Nikon
Nikon
Nikon
Nikon
Olympus
Olympus
Olympus
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
U300
X-350
C-760
C-5060
X1
U-mini
Lumix-FZ20
DMC-FX7GD
Lumix LC33
LUMIX DMC-F1
Optio-S40
Optio-S50
Optio 33LF
Optio MX
Digimax-420
Digimax-400
Sora PDR-T30
Coolpix 5900
Coolpix S1
Coolpix 7600
DMC-FX7
Dimage Xt
AZ-1
Olympus
Olympus
Olympus
Olympus
Olympus
Olympus
Panasonic
Panasonic
Panasonic
Panasonic
Pentax
Pentax
Pentax
Pentax
Samsung
Samsung
Toshiba
Nikon
Nikon
Nikon
Panasonic
Minolta
Olympus
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
Digital Camera
USB FLASH ‫ﻗﺮﺹ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻛﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻉ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻛﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻉ‬
Cruzer Micro
Cruzer Mini
Cruzer Mini
SONY Micro Vault
FLEX DRIVE
AnyDrive
Sandisk
Sandisk
Sandisk
Sony
Serotech
A.L tech
USB 2.0 USB Flash Drive 128M
USB 2.0 128M
USB 2.0 256M
USB 2.0 64MB
USB 2.0 32MB
USB 2.0 128MB
XTICK
Micro Mini
iFlash
LG
RiDATA
LG
Iomega
Imation
XTICK(M)
EZDrive
USB 2.0 128M
USB 2.0 128M
USB 2.0 64M
USB 2.0 64M
USB 2.0 64M
MP3 ‫ﻣﺸﻐّﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻛﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻉ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻛﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻉ‬
Creative MuVo NX128M
Iriver H320
YH-920
YP-T7
YP-MT6
YP-T6
YP-53
YP-ST5
YP-T5
YP-60
Creative
Iriver
Samsung
Samsung
Samsung
Samsung
Samsung
Samsung
Samsung
Samsung
128 MB MP3 Player
20G HDD MP3 Player
20G HDD MP3 Player
MP3 Player
MP3 Player
MP3 Player
MP3 Player
MP3 Player
MP3 Player
MP3 Player
YP-780
YP-35
YP-55
iAUDIO U2
iAUDIO G3
iAudio M3
SI-M500L
H10
YP-T5 VB
YP-53
Samsung
Samsung
Samsung
Cowon
Cowon
Cowon
Sharp
Iriver
Samsung
Samsung
MP3 Player
MP3 Player
MP3 Player
MP3 Player
MP3 Player
HDD MP3 Player
256MB MP3 Player
MP3 Player
MP3 Player
256MB MP3 Player
٥٨
2/28/2008 3:33:23 PM
‫ﺗﺤﻮﻃﺎﺕ ﺣﻮﻝ ﻣﻌﺎﻟﺠﺔ ﺍﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ ﻭﺗﺨﺰﻳﻨﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺍﺻﻔﺎﺕ‬
‫‪ARA‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻠﺤﻘﺎﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻠﺤﻘﺎﺕ‬
‫ﻓﺪ ﺗﻘﻠﻞ ﺍﻟﺨﺪﻭﺵ ﺍﻟﺼﻐﻴﺮﺓ ﻧﻮﻋﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻭﺗﺘﺴﺒﺐ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻧﻘﻄﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‪ .‬ﺍﻧﺘﺒﻪ ﻟﻌﺪﻡ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺨﺪﻭﺵ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻣﻌﺎﻟﺠﺘﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻣﻌﺎﻟﺠﺔ ﺍﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻮﺯﻥ‬
‫‪ 4.0‬ﻛﻠﺞ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺑﻌﺎﺩ‬
‫‪) 470‬ﻋﺮﺽ( × ‪) 196‬ﺍﺭﺗﻔﺎﻉ( × ‪) 116‬ﻋﻤﻖ( ﻣﻠﻢ‬
‫ﻧﻄﺎﻕ ﺩﺭﺟﺔ ﺍﻟﺤﺮﺍﺭﺓ ﻟﻠﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫‪35°C+ ~°C 5 +‬‬
‫ﻧﻄﺎﻕ ﺍﻟﺮﻃﻮﺑﺔ ﻟﻠﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ‬
‫‪75% ~ 10%‬‬
‫‪) DVD‬ﻗﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ(‬
‫ﺗﺨﺰﻳﻦ ﺍﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ‬
‫ﺍﺣﻔﻈﻬﺎ ﻓﻲ ﻏﻼﻑ ﻧﻈﻴﻒ ﻟﻠﺤﻤﺎﻳﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﺧﺰّﻧﻬﺎ ﻋﻤﻮﺩﻳﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‬
‫ﺍﺣﻔﻈﻬﺎ ﻓﻲ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻬﻮﻳﺔ ﻭﺑﺎﺭﺩ‪.‬‬
‫‪ CD : 12‬ﺳﻢ )ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻣﺞ(‬
‫ﻻ ﺗﺤﻔﻈﻬﺎ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺃﺷﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺍﻟﻤﺒﺎﺷﺮﺓ‪.‬‬
‫‪ CD : 8‬ﺳﻢ )ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻣﺞ(‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺐ‬
‫ﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﻤﻜﻮﻥ‬
‫‪) HDMI‬ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭﻱ(‬
‫ﺳﺮﻋﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺍءﺓ ‪ 4.06 ~ 3.49 :‬ﻡ‪/‬ﺛﺎﻧﻴﺔ‬
‫ﻭﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ )ﻗﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻪ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﺴﻄﺢ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺪ( ‪ 135 :‬ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎ‬
‫ﺳﺮﻋﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺍءﺓ ‪ 4.8 ~ 5.6 :‬ﻡ‪/‬ﺛﺎﻧﻴﺔ‬
‫ﻭﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ ‪ 74 :‬ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ‬
‫ﺳﺮﻋﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺍءﺓ ‪ 4.8 ~ 5.6 :‬ﻡ‪/‬ﺛﺎﻧﻴﺔ‬
‫ﻭﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ ‪ 20 :‬ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ‬
‫ﻗﻨﺎﺓ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ‪) 1.0Vp-p :‬ﺣﻤﻞ ‪،(Ω 75‬‬
‫‪) Y : 1.0Vp-p‬ﺣﻤﻞ ‪،(Ω 75‬‬
‫‪) Pr : 0.70 Vp-p‬ﺣﻤﻞ ‪(Ω 75‬‬
‫‪) Pb : 0.70 Vp-p‬ﺣﻤﻞ ‪(Ω 75‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻌﺎﻭﻗﺔ‪Ω115~85 :‬‬
‫ﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻲ‬
‫‪ 100‬ﻭﺍﻁ × ‪(Ω 3)2‬‬
‫ﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ‬
‫‪ 100‬ﻭﺍﻁ ×)‪(Ω 3‬‬
‫ﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻲ‬
‫‪ 100‬ﻭﺍﻁ × ‪(Ω 3)2‬‬
‫ﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ‬
‫‪ 100‬ﻭﺍﻁ ×)‪(Ω 3‬‬
‫ﻧﻄﺎﻕ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺩﺩ‬
‫‪ 20‬ﻫﺮﺗﺰ ~ ‪ 20‬ﻛﻴﻠﻮﻫﺮﺗﺰ‬
‫ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﺠﺪ ﺑﺼﻤﺔ ﺍﻹﺻﺒﻊ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻐﺒﺎﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪ّ ،‬‬
‫ﻧﻈﻔﻬﺎ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻣﻄﻬﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﺪﻝ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﻤﺎء ﻭﺍﻣﺴﺢ ﺑﻘﻤﺎﺵ ﻧﺎﻋﻢ‬
‫ﻧﺴﺒﺔ ﺍﻹﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻀﻮﺿﺎء‬
‫‪ 70‬ﺩﻳﺴﻴﺒﻞ‬
‫• ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻟﺘﻨﻈﻴﻒ ﺍﻣﺴﺢ ﺑﻌﻨﺎﻳﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﻰ ﺧﺎﺭﺟﻪ ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﻨﺎﺓ‬
‫‪ 60‬ﺩﻳﺴﻴﺒﻞ‬
‫ﺣﺴﺎﺳﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻞ‬
‫‪(AUX) 400 mV‬‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻻ ﺗﻠﻮﺙ ﺍﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ ﺑﺎﻟﻐﺒﺎﺭ‪.‬‬
‫‪ ‬ﻻ ﺗﺤﻤﻞ ﺃﻗﺮﺍﺹ ﻣﻜﺴﻮﺭﺓ ﺃﻭ ﻣﺤﻔﻮﺭﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻣﻌﺎﻟﺠﺔ ﺍﻷﻗﺮﺍﺹ ﻭﺗﺨﺰﻳﻨﻬﺎ‬
‫‪M‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻀﺨﻢ‬
‫ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫‪ ‬ﻗﺪ ﻳﺤﺪﺙ ﺗﻜﺎﺛﻒ ﺍﻟﺮﻃﻮﺑﺔ ﺍﺫﺍ ﻻﻣﺲ ﺍﻟﻬﻮﺍء ﺍﻟﺪﺍﻓﺊ ﺃﺟﺰﺍء ﺑﺎﺭﺩﺓ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐﻞ‪ .‬ﻋﻨﺪ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺍﻟﺘﻜﺎﺛﻒ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐﻞ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐﻞ ﺑﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺻﺤﻴﺤﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻨﺪ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺤﺎﻟﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﺯﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﻭﺍﺗﺮﻙ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﻐﻞ ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﻟﻤﺪﺓ ﺳﺎﻋﺔ ﺃﻭ ﺳﺎﻋﺘﻴﻦ ﻣﻊ‬
‫ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﻌﺎﻭﻗﺔ‬
‫ﻧﻄﺎﻕ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺩﺩ‬
‫ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺿﻐﻂ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻲ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻘﺪﺭ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺤﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺑﻌﺎﺩ )ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ × ﺍﻻﺭﺗﻔﺎﻉ × ﺍﻟﻌﻤﻖ(‬
‫ﺍﻟﻮﺯﻥ‬
‫● ﺍﻟﻤﻠﺤﻘﺎﺕ‬
‫ﻻ ﺗﻠﻤﺲ ﺟﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻟﻠﻘﺮﺹ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻣﺴﻚ ﺣﺎﻓﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ ﻟﻤﻨﻊ ﺑﺼﻤﺔ ﺍﻹﺻﺒﻊ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﻄﺢ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪.‬‬
‫ﻻ ﺗﻀﻊ ﻭﺭﻗﺔ ﻻﺻﻘﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺹ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ‬
‫ﺍﺳﺘﻬﻼﻙ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ‬
‫‪ 55‬ﻭﺍﻁ‬
‫ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﻣﻜﺒﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﻟﻘﻨﺎﺓ ‪5.1‬‬
‫ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻲ‪/‬ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻲ‪ /‬ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ‬
‫‪Ω3‬‬
‫‪ 135‬ﻫﺮﺗﺰ ~ ‪ 20‬ﻛﻴﻠﻮﻫﺮﺗﺰ‬
‫‪ 86‬ﺩﻳﺴﻴﺒﻞ‬
‫‪ 100‬ﻭﺍﻁ‬
‫‪ 200‬ﻭﺍﻁ‬
‫ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻲ‪/‬ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻲ ‪108×246×218 :‬ﻣﻠﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ ‪ 376×83.5×142 :‬ﻣﻠﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ ‪ 180 ×389×396:‬ﻣﻠﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻣﻲ ‪ 1.1 :‬ﻛﻠﺞ‪ ,‬ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻲ ‪ 0.95 :‬ﻛﻠﺞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺰﻱ ‪ 1.2 :‬ﻛﻠﺞ‪ ,‬ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ ‪ 6.4 :‬ﻛﻠﺞ‬
‫ﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﻲ‬
‫‪Ω3‬‬
‫‪ 160‬ﻫﺮﺗﺰ ~ ‪ 35‬ﻛﻴﻠﻮﻫﺮﺗﺰ‬
‫‪ 86‬ﺩﻳﺴﻴﺒﻞ‬
‫‪ 100‬ﻭﺍﻁ‬
‫‪ 200‬ﻭﺍﻁ‬
‫*‪ :‬ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺍﺻﻔﺎﺕ ﺍﻻﺳﻤﻴﺔ‬
‫ ﺗﺤﺘﻔﻆ ﺷﺮﻛﺔ ‪ Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd‬ﺑﺤﻖ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺍﺻﻔﺎﺕ ﺩﻭﻥ ﺇﺷﻌﺎﺭ‪.‬‬‫‪ -‬ﻗﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﻮﺯﻥ ﻭﺍﻷﺑﻌﺎﺩ ﻫﻲ ﻗﻴﻢ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫‪٦٠‬‬
‫‪2/28/2008 3:33:23 PM‬‬
‫‪٦١‬‬
‫‪HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 60-61‬‬
‫ﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ ﻋﺎﻟﻤﻴﺔ ﺍﻻﻧﺘﺸﺎﺭ‬
.‫ ﻳﺮﺟﻰ ﺍﻻﺗﺼﺎﻝ ﺑﻤﺮﻛﺰ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ ﻟﻠﺰﺑﺎﺋﻦ‬،‫ﺍﺫﺍ ﻭﺟﺪ ﺃﻱ ﺳﺆﺍﻝ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻱ ﺗﻘﺪﻳﺮ ﺣﻮﻝ ﻣﻨﺘﺠﺎﺕ ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻧﺞ‬
Region
North America
Latin America
Country
CANADA
MEXICO
U.S.A
ARGENTINE
BRAZIL
CHILE
NICARAGUA
HONDURAS
COSTA RICA
ECUADOR
EL SALVADOR
GUATEMALA
JAMAICA
PANAMA
PUERTO RICO
REP. DOMINICA
TRINIDAD & TOBAGO
VENEZUELA
COLOMBIA
BELGIUM
CIS
Asia Pacific
Middle East &
Africa
HT-XA100,XA100C(ARA).indd 62
Web Site
DENMARK
FINLAND
FRANCE
3260 SAMSUNG (€ 0,15/Min),
08 25 08 65 65 (€ 0,15/Min)
www.samsung.com
GERMANY
HUNGARY
ITALIA
LUXEMBURG
NETHERLANDS
NORWAY
POLAND
PORTUGAL
SLOVAKIA
SPAIN
SWEDEN
U.K
EIRE
AUSTRIA
SWITZERLAND
RUSSIA
KAZAHSTAN
UZBEKISTAN
KYRGYZSTAN
TADJIKISTAN
UKRAINE
LITHUANIA
LATVIA
ESTONIA
AUSTRALIA
NEW ZEALAND
CHINA
HONG KONG
INDIA
INDONESIA
JAPAN
MALAYSIA
PHILIPPINES
SINGAPORE
THAILAND
TAIWAN
VIETNAM
TURKEY
SOUTH AFRICA
U.A.E
01805 - SAMSUNG(726-7864) (€ 0,14/Min)
06-80-SAMSUNG(726-7864)
800-SAMSUNG(726-7864)
0035 (0)2 261 03 710
0900-SAMSUNG(726-7864) (€ 0,10/Min)
815-56 480
0 801 801 881 , 022-607-93-33
80820-SAMSUNG(726-7864)
0800-SAMSUNG(726-7864)
902 10 11 30
0771-400 200
0845 SAMSUNG (7267864)
0818 717 100
0800-SAMSUNG(726-7864)
0800-SAMSUNG(726-7864)
8-800-555-55-55
8-10-800-500-55-500
8-10-800-500-55-500
00-800-500-55-500
8-10-800-500-55-500
8-800-502-0000
8-800-77777
800-7267
800-7267
1300 362 603
0800SAMSUNG(726-7864)
800-810-5858 , 010-6475 1880
3698-4698
3030 8282 , 1800 110011
0800-112-8888
0120-327-527
1800-88-9999
1800-10-SAMSUNG(726-7864)
1800-SAMSUNG(726-7864)
1800-29-3232 , 02-689-3232
0800-329-999
1 800 588 889
444 77 11
0860-SAMSUNG(726-7864 )
800-SAMSUNG (726-7864), 8000-4726
www.samsung.com
www.samsung.com
www.samsung.com
www.samsung.com/be
www.samsung.com/nl
www.samsung.com/no
www.samsung.com/pl
www.samsung.com/pt
www.samsung.com/sk
www.samsung.com
www.samsung.com/se
www.samsung.com
www.samsung.com/ie
www.samsung.com/at
www.samsung.com/ch
www.samsung.com
www.samsung.kz
www.samsung.uz
CZECH REPUBLIC
Europe
Customer Care Center 1-800-SAMSUNG(726-7864)
01-800-SAMSUNG(726-7864)
1-800-SAMSUNG(726-7864)
0800-333-3733
0800-124-421 , 4004-0000
800-SAMSUNG(726-7864)
00-1800-5077267
800-7919267
0-800-507-7267
1-800-10-7267
800-6225
1-800-299-0013
1-800-234-7267
800-7267
1-800-682-3180
1-800-751-2676
1-800-SAMSUNG(726-7864)
0-800-100-5303
01-8000112112
0032 (0)2 201 24 18
844 000 844
Distributor pro Českou republiku:
Samsung Zrt., česka organizační složka
Vyskočilova 4, 14000 Praha 4
70 70 19 70
030-6227 515
www.samsung.com/ca
www.samsung.com
www.samsung.com
www.samsung.com/ar
www.samsung.com
www.samsung.com/cl
www.samsung.com/latin
www.samsung.com/latin
www.samsung.com/latin
www.samsung.com/latin
www.samsung.com/latin
www.samsung.com/latin
www.samsung.com/latin
www.samsung.com/latin
www.samsung.com/latin
www.samsung.com/latin
www.samsung.com.co
www.samsung.com/be
www.samsung.com/cz
www.samsung.com/dk
www.samsung.com/fi
www.samsung.com
www.samsung.lt
www.samsung.com/lv
www.samsung.ee
www.samsung.com
www.samsung.com/nz
www.samsung.com
www.samsung.com/hk
www.samsung.com
www.samsung.com
www.samsung.com/jp
www.samsung.com/my
www.samsung.com/ph
www.samsung.com
www.samsung.com
www.samsung.com/tw
www.samsung.com
www.samsung.com
www.samsung.com
www.samsung.com
2/28/2008 3:33:23 PM